gdb: fix building with system readline
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
... / ...
CommitLineData
1/* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22#include "defs.h"
23#include "arch-utils.h"
24#include <ctype.h>
25#include "hashtab.h"
26#include "symtab.h"
27#include "frame.h"
28#include "breakpoint.h"
29#include "tracepoint.h"
30#include "gdbtypes.h"
31#include "expression.h"
32#include "gdbcore.h"
33#include "gdbcmd.h"
34#include "value.h"
35#include "command.h"
36#include "inferior.h"
37#include "gdbthread.h"
38#include "target.h"
39#include "language.h"
40#include "gdb_string.h"
41#include "demangle.h"
42#include "annotate.h"
43#include "symfile.h"
44#include "objfiles.h"
45#include "source.h"
46#include "linespec.h"
47#include "completer.h"
48#include "gdb.h"
49#include "ui-out.h"
50#include "cli/cli-script.h"
51#include "gdb_assert.h"
52#include "block.h"
53#include "solib.h"
54#include "solist.h"
55#include "observer.h"
56#include "exceptions.h"
57#include "memattr.h"
58#include "ada-lang.h"
59#include "top.h"
60#include "wrapper.h"
61#include "valprint.h"
62#include "jit.h"
63#include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65/* readline include files */
66#include "readline/readline.h"
67#include "readline/history.h"
68
69/* readline defines this. */
70#undef savestring
71
72#include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74/* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75#define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76#define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78/* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
131 struct bp_location *loc2);
132
133static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
134
135static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
136
137static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
138
139static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
140
141static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
142
143static void commands_command (char *, int);
144
145static void condition_command (char *, int);
146
147static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
148
149void set_breakpoint_count (int);
150
151typedef enum
152 {
153 mark_inserted,
154 mark_uninserted
155 }
156insertion_state_t;
157
158static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
159static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
160
161static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
162
163static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
164
165static int watchpoint_check (void *);
166
167static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
168
169static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
170
171static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
172
173static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
174
175static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
176
177static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
178
179static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
180
181static void awatch_command (char *, int);
182
183static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
184
185static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
186
187static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
188
189static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
190
191static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
192
193static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
194 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
195
196static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
197
198static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
199
200static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
201 CORE_ADDR pc);
202
203static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
204
205static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207static void update_global_location_list (int);
208
209static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
210
211static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
212
213static int is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
214
215static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
216
217static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
218
219static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
220
221static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
222
223static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
224
225static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
226
227static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
228
229static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
230
231
232/* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
233 current breakpoint. */
234
235static int breakpoint_proceeded;
236
237static const char *
238bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
239{
240 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
241 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
242 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
243 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
244}
245
246/* Prototypes for exported functions. */
247/* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
248 if such is available. */
249static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
250
251static void
252show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
253 struct cmd_list_element *c,
254 const char *value)
255{
256 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
257Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
258 value);
259}
260
261/* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
262 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
263 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
264 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
265static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
266static void
267show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
268 struct cmd_list_element *c,
269 const char *value)
270{
271 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
272Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
273 value);
274}
275
276/* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
277 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
278 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
279 use hardware breakpoints. */
280static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
281static void
282show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
283 struct cmd_list_element *c,
284 const char *value)
285{
286 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
287Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
288 value);
289}
290
291/* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
292 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
293 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
294 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
295 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
296
297static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
298static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
299static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
300static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
301 always_inserted_auto,
302 always_inserted_off,
303 always_inserted_on,
304 NULL
305};
306static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
307static void
308show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
309 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
310{
311 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
312 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
313Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
314 value,
315 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
316 else
317 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
318}
319
320int
321breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
322{
323 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
324 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
325}
326
327void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
328
329/* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
330static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
331
332/* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
333static int overlay_events_enabled;
334
335/* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
336 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
337 breakpoint. */
338
339#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
340
341#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
342 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
343 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
344 B = TMP)
345
346/* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
347 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
348 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
349
350#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
351 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
352 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
353 BP_TMP++)
354
355/* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
356
357#define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
358 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
359 if (tracepoint_type (B))
360
361/* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
362
363struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
364
365/* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
366
367static struct bp_location **bp_location;
368
369/* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
370
371static unsigned bp_location_count;
372
373/* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
374 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
375 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
376 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
377
378static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
379
380/* Maximum offset plus alignment between
381 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
382 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
383 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
384 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
385
386static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
387
388/* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
389 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
390 may still be reported by a target. */
391VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
392
393/* Number of last breakpoint made. */
394
395int breakpoint_count;
396
397/* Number of last tracepoint made. */
398
399int tracepoint_count;
400
401/* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
402static int
403breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
404{
405 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
406}
407
408/* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
409
410void
411set_breakpoint_count (int num)
412{
413 breakpoint_count = num;
414 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
415}
416
417/* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
418
419void
420clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
421{
422 struct breakpoint *b;
423
424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
425 b->hit_count = 0;
426}
427
428/* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
429
430static int
431tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
432{
433 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
434}
435
436/* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
437 for "break" command with no arg.
438 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
439 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
440
441 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
442
443int default_breakpoint_valid;
444CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
445struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
446int default_breakpoint_line;
447struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
448
449\f
450/* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
451 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
452
453 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
454 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
455 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
456
457 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
458
459 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
460 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
461static int
462get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
463{
464 int retval = 0; /* default */
465 char *p = *pp;
466
467 if (p == NULL)
468 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
469 return breakpoint_count;
470 else if (*p == '$')
471 {
472 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
473 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
474 char *varname;
475 char *start = ++p;
476 LONGEST val;
477
478 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
479 p++;
480 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
481 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
482 varname[p - start] = '\0';
483 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
484 retval = (int) val;
485 else
486 {
487 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
488 retval = 0;
489 }
490 }
491 else
492 {
493 if (*p == '-')
494 ++p;
495 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
496 ++p;
497 if (p == *pp)
498 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
499 {
500 /* Skip non-numeric token */
501 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
502 ++p;
503 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
504 retval = 0;
505 }
506 else
507 retval = atoi (*pp);
508 }
509 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
510 {
511 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
512 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
513 ++p;
514 retval = 0;
515 }
516 while (isspace (*p))
517 p++;
518 *pp = p;
519 return retval;
520}
521
522
523/* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
524int
525get_number (char **pp)
526{
527 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
528}
529
530/* Parse a number or a range.
531 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
532 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
533 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
534 * inclusive.
535 *
536 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
537 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
538 *
539 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
540 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
541 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
542 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
543 * pointer PP past <number2>.
544 */
545
546int
547get_number_or_range (char **pp)
548{
549 static int last_retval, end_value;
550 static char *end_ptr;
551 static int in_range = 0;
552
553 if (**pp != '-')
554 {
555 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
556 or to the first number of a range. */
557 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
558 if (**pp == '-')
559 {
560 char **temp;
561
562 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
563 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
564 and also remember the end of the final token. */
565
566 temp = &end_ptr;
567 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
568 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
569 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
570 end_value = get_number (temp);
571 if (end_value < last_retval)
572 {
573 error (_("inverted range"));
574 }
575 else if (end_value == last_retval)
576 {
577 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
578 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
579 single number. */
580 *pp = end_ptr;
581 }
582 else
583 in_range = 1;
584 }
585 }
586 else if (! in_range)
587 error (_("negative value"));
588 else
589 {
590 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
591 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
592 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
593 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
594 is reached. */
595
596 if (++last_retval == end_value)
597 {
598 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
599 *pp = end_ptr;
600 in_range = 0;
601 }
602 }
603 return last_retval;
604}
605
606/* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
607 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
608
609struct breakpoint *
610get_breakpoint (int num)
611{
612 struct breakpoint *b;
613
614 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
615 if (b->number == num)
616 return b;
617
618 return NULL;
619}
620
621\f
622/* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
623
624static void
625condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
626{
627 struct breakpoint *b;
628 char *p;
629 int bnum;
630
631 if (arg == 0)
632 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
633
634 p = arg;
635 bnum = get_number (&p);
636 if (bnum == 0)
637 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
638
639 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
640 if (b->number == bnum)
641 {
642 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
643 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
644 {
645 xfree (loc->cond);
646 loc->cond = NULL;
647 }
648 xfree (b->cond_string);
649 b->cond_string = NULL;
650 xfree (b->cond_exp);
651 b->cond_exp = NULL;
652
653 if (*p == 0)
654 {
655 if (from_tty)
656 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
657 }
658 else
659 {
660 arg = p;
661 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
662 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
663 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
664 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
665
666 if (is_watchpoint (b))
667 {
668 innermost_block = NULL;
669 arg = p;
670 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
671 if (*arg)
672 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
673 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
674 }
675 else
676 {
677 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
678 {
679 arg = p;
680 loc->cond =
681 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
682 if (*arg)
683 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
684 }
685 }
686 }
687 breakpoints_changed ();
688 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
689 return;
690 }
691
692 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
693}
694
695/* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
696
697void
698breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
699{
700 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
701 b->commands = commands;
702 breakpoints_changed ();
703 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
704}
705
706static void
707commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
708{
709 struct breakpoint *b;
710 char *p;
711 int bnum;
712 struct command_line *l;
713
714 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
715 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
716 being read from. */
717
718 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
719 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
720
721 p = arg;
722 bnum = get_number (&p);
723
724 if (p && *p)
725 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
726
727 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
728 if (b->number == bnum)
729 {
730 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
731 bnum);
732 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
733 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
734 do_cleanups (cleanups);
735 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
736 return;
737 }
738 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
739}
740
741/* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
742 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
743
744 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
745 that are part of if and while bodies. */
746enum command_control_type
747commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
748{
749 struct breakpoint *b;
750 char *p;
751 int bnum;
752
753 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
754 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
755 being read from. */
756
757 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
758 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
759
760 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
761 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
762 if (arg && !*arg)
763 p = NULL;
764 else
765 p = arg;
766 bnum = get_number (&p);
767
768 if (p && *p)
769 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
770
771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
772 if (b->number == bnum)
773 {
774 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
775 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
776 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
777 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
778 list after it finishes execution. */
779 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
780 breakpoints_changed ();
781 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
782 return simple_control;
783 }
784 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
785}
786
787/* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
788
789static int
790bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
791{
792 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
793 return 0;
794 if (!bl->inserted)
795 return 0;
796 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
797 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
798 return 0;
799 return 1;
800}
801
802/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
803 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
804
805 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
806 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
807 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
808 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
809 memaddr ... memaddr + len
810 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
811 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
812 and:
813 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
814
815void
816breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
817{
818 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
819 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
820
821 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
822 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
823
824 bc_l = 0;
825 bc_r = bp_location_count;
826 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
827 {
828 struct bp_location *b;
829
830 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
831 b = bp_location[bc];
832
833 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
834 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
835 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
836
837 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
838 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
839 MEMADDR. */
840
841 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
842 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
843 bc_l = bc;
844 else
845 bc_r = bc;
846 }
847
848 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
849
850 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
851 {
852 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
853 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
854 int bp_size = 0;
855 int bptoffset = 0;
856
857 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
858 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
859 b->owner->number);
860
861 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
862 content. */
863
864 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
865 && memaddr + len <= b->address
866 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
867 break;
868
869 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
870 continue;
871 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
872 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
873 continue;
874
875 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
876 we need to copy. */
877 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
878 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
879
880 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
881 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
882 are reading. */
883 continue;
884
885 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
886 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
887 reading. */
888 continue;
889
890 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
891 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
892 {
893 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
894 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
895 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
896 bp_addr = memaddr;
897 }
898
899 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
900 {
901 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
902 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
903 }
904
905 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
906 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
907 }
908}
909\f
910
911/* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
912static void
913insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
914{
915 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
916 int val = -1;
917
918 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
919 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
920
921 b->ops->insert (b);
922}
923
924/* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
925
926static int
927is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
928{
929 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
930 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
931 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
932}
933
934/* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
935 software. */
936
937static int
938is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
939{
940 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
941 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
942}
943
944/* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
945 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
946 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
947 not need them.
948
949 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
950 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
951 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
952 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
953 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
954
955 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
956 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
957 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
958 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
959
960 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
961 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
962 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
963 chain. */
964
965static void
966fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
967 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
968{
969 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
970 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
971
972 *valp = NULL;
973 if (resultp)
974 *resultp = NULL;
975 if (val_chain)
976 *val_chain = NULL;
977
978 /* Evaluate the expression. */
979 mark = value_mark ();
980 result = NULL;
981
982 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
983 {
984 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
985 }
986 if (ex.reason < 0)
987 {
988 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
989 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
990 error to some higher catcher. */
991 switch (ex.error)
992 {
993 case MEMORY_ERROR:
994 break;
995 default:
996 throw_exception (ex);
997 break;
998 }
999 }
1000
1001 new_mark = value_mark ();
1002 if (mark == new_mark)
1003 return;
1004 if (resultp)
1005 *resultp = result;
1006
1007 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
1008 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
1009 if (result != NULL
1010 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
1011 *valp = result;
1012
1013 if (val_chain)
1014 {
1015 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
1016 decide which addresses to watch. */
1017 *val_chain = new_mark;
1018 value_release_to_mark (mark);
1019 }
1020}
1021
1022/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1023 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1024 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1025 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1026 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1027 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1028 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1029 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1030 running. */
1031
1032static int
1033watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1034{
1035 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1036 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1037 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1038}
1039
1040/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1041 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1042 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1043 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1044 in b->loc->cond.
1045 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1046
1047 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1048 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1049
1050 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1051 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1052 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1053 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1054 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1055 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1056 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1057
1058 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1059 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1060 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1061 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1062 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1063 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1064 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1065 memory content has not changed.
1066
1067 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1068 watchpoints:
1069
1070 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1071 several times when GDB stops.
1072
1073 [linux]
1074 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1075 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1076 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1077 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1078 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1079 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1080 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1081 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1082 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1083 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1084
1085 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1086 removal from inferior. */
1087
1088static void
1089update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1090{
1091 int within_current_scope;
1092 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1093 struct bp_location *loc;
1094 int frame_saved;
1095 bpstat bs;
1096
1097 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1098 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1099 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1100 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1101 return;
1102
1103 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1104 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1105 breakpoints if needed. */
1106 b->loc = NULL;
1107
1108 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1109 return;
1110
1111 frame_saved = 0;
1112
1113 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1114 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1115 within_current_scope = 1;
1116 else
1117 {
1118 struct frame_info *fi;
1119
1120 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1121 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1122 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1123 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1124 selected frame. */
1125 frame_saved = 1;
1126 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1127
1128 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1129 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1130 if (within_current_scope)
1131 select_frame (fi);
1132 }
1133
1134 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1135 {
1136 char *s;
1137 if (b->exp)
1138 {
1139 xfree (b->exp);
1140 b->exp = NULL;
1141 }
1142 s = b->exp_string;
1143 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1144 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1145 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1146 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1147 be completely different objects. */
1148 value_free (b->val);
1149 b->val = NULL;
1150 b->val_valid = 0;
1151
1152 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1153 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1154 locations (re)created below. */
1155 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1156 {
1157 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1158 {
1159 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1160 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1161 }
1162
1163 s = b->cond_string;
1164 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1169 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1170 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1171 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1172 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1173 if ( !target_has_execution)
1174 {
1175 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1176 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1177 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1178 }
1179 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1180 {
1181 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1182 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1183
1184 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1185
1186 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1187 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1188 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1189 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1190 if (!b->val_valid)
1191 {
1192 b->val = v;
1193 b->val_valid = 1;
1194 }
1195
1196 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1197 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1198 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1199 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1200 && reparse)
1201 {
1202 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1203
1204 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1205 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1206 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1207 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1208 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1209 watchpoint. */
1210 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1211 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1212 &other_type_used);
1213 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1214
1215 if (!mem_cnt)
1216 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1217 else
1218 {
1219 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1220 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1221 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1222 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1223 else
1224 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1225 }
1226 }
1227
1228 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1229
1230 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1231 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1232 {
1233 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1234 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1235 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1236 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1237 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1238 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1239 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1240 {
1241 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1242
1243 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1244 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1245 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1246 if (v == result
1247 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1248 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1249 {
1250 CORE_ADDR addr;
1251 int len, type;
1252 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1253
1254 addr = value_address (v);
1255 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1256 type = hw_write;
1257 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1258 type = hw_read;
1259 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1260 type = hw_access;
1261
1262 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1263 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1264 ;
1265 *tmp = loc;
1266 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1267
1268 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1269 loc->address = addr;
1270 loc->length = len;
1271 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1272 }
1273 }
1274
1275 next = value_next (v);
1276 if (v != b->val)
1277 value_free (v);
1278 }
1279
1280 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1281 above left it without any location set up. But,
1282 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1283 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1284 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1285 {
1286 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1287 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1288 b->loc->address = -1;
1289 b->loc->length = -1;
1290 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1291 }
1292 }
1293 else if (!within_current_scope)
1294 {
1295 printf_filtered (_("\
1296Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1297in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1298 b->number);
1299 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1300 {
1301 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1302 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1303 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1304 }
1305 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1306 }
1307
1308 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1309 if (frame_saved)
1310 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1311}
1312
1313
1314/* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1315 inserted in the inferior. */
1316static int
1317should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1318{
1319 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1320 return 0;
1321
1322 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1323 return 0;
1324
1325 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1326 return 0;
1327
1328 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1329 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1330 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1331 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1332 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1333 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1334 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1335 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1336 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1337 return 0;
1338
1339 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1340 not by us. */
1341 if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1342 return 0;
1343
1344 return 1;
1345}
1346
1347/* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1348 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1349 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1350
1351 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1352 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1353static int
1354insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1355 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1356 int *disabled_breaks,
1357 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1358{
1359 int val = 0;
1360
1361 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1362 return 0;
1363
1364 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1365 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1366 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1367 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1368
1369 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1370 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1371 {
1372 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1373 {
1374 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1375 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1376 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1377 Two important cases are:
1378 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1379 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1380 hardware breakpoint.
1381 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1382 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1383 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1384
1385 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1386 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1387 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1388 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1389 struct mem_region *mr
1390 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1391
1392 if (mr)
1393 {
1394 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1395 {
1396 int changed = 0;
1397 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1398
1399 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1400 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1401 else
1402 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1403
1404 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1405 {
1406 static int said = 0;
1407 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1408 if (!said)
1409 {
1410 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1411Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1412 said = 1;
1413 }
1414 }
1415 }
1416 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1417 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1418 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1419 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1420 }
1421 }
1422
1423 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1424 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1425 || bpt->section == NULL
1426 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1427 {
1428 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1429
1430 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1431 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1432 &bpt->target_info);
1433 else
1434 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1435 &bpt->target_info);
1436 }
1437 else
1438 {
1439 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1440 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1441 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1442 {
1443 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1444 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1445 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1446 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1447 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1448 bpt->owner->number);
1449 else
1450 {
1451 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1452 bpt->section);
1453 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1454 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1455 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1456 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1457 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1458 if (val != 0)
1459 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1460 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1461 bpt->owner->number);
1462 }
1463 }
1464 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1465 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1466 {
1467 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1468 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1469 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1470 &bpt->target_info);
1471 else
1472 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1473 &bpt->target_info);
1474 }
1475 else
1476 {
1477 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1478 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1479 return 0;
1480 }
1481 }
1482
1483 if (val)
1484 {
1485 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1486 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1487 {
1488 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1489 val = 0;
1490 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1491 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1492 {
1493 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1494 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1495 bpt->owner->number);
1496 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1497 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1498 }
1499 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1500 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1501 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1502 }
1503 else
1504 {
1505 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1506 {
1507 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1508 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1509 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1510 bpt->owner->number);
1511 }
1512 else
1513 {
1514 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1515 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1516 bpt->owner->number);
1517 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1518 "Error accessing memory address ");
1519 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1520 tmp_error_stream);
1521 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1522 safe_strerror (val));
1523 }
1524
1525 }
1526 }
1527 else
1528 bpt->inserted = 1;
1529
1530 return val;
1531 }
1532
1533 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1534 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1535 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1536 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1537 {
1538 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1539 bpt->length,
1540 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1541
1542 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1543 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1544 if (val == 1 && bpt->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1545 {
1546 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1547
1548 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1549 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1550 of this one. */
1551 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1552 if (loc != bpt
1553 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1554 && watchpoint_locations_match (bpt, loc))
1555 {
1556 bpt->duplicate = 1;
1557 bpt->inserted = 1;
1558 bpt->target_info = loc->target_info;
1559 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1560 val = 0;
1561 break;
1562 }
1563
1564 if (val == 1)
1565 {
1566 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1567 bpt->length,
1568 hw_access);
1569 if (val == 0)
1570 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1571 }
1572 }
1573
1574 bpt->inserted = (val == 0);
1575 }
1576
1577 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1578 {
1579 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1580 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1581 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1582 bpt->owner->number);
1583 if (e.reason < 0)
1584 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1585 else
1586 bpt->inserted = 1;
1587
1588 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1589 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1590 so just return success. */
1591 return 0;
1592 }
1593
1594 return 0;
1595}
1596
1597/* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1598 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1599 PSPACE anymore. */
1600
1601void
1602breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1603{
1604 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1605 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1606
1607 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1608 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1609 {
1610 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1611 delete_breakpoint (b);
1612 }
1613
1614 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1615 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1616 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1617 {
1618 struct bp_location *tmp;
1619
1620 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1621 {
1622 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1623 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1624 else
1625 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1626 if (tmp->next == loc)
1627 {
1628 tmp->next = loc->next;
1629 break;
1630 }
1631 }
1632 }
1633
1634 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1635 removed locations above. */
1636 update_global_location_list (0);
1637}
1638
1639/* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1640 Throws exception on any error.
1641 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1642 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1643void
1644insert_breakpoints (void)
1645{
1646 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1647
1648 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1649 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1650 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1651
1652 update_global_location_list (1);
1653
1654 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1655 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1656 now. */
1657 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1658 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1659}
1660
1661/* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1662 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1663 Both return zero if successful,
1664 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1665
1666static void
1667insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1668{
1669 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1670 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1671 int error = 0;
1672 int val = 0;
1673 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1674 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1675
1676 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1677 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1678
1679 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1680 there was an error. */
1681 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1682
1683 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1684
1685 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1686 {
1687 struct thread_info *tp;
1688 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1689
1690 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1691 continue;
1692
1693 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1694 thread no longer exists. */
1695 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1696 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1697 continue;
1698
1699 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1700
1701 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1702 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1703 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1704 insert breakpoints. */
1705 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1706 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1707 continue;
1708
1709 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1710 &disabled_breaks,
1711 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1712 if (val)
1713 error = val;
1714 }
1715
1716 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1717 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1718 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1719 {
1720 int some_failed = 0;
1721 struct bp_location *loc;
1722
1723 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1724 continue;
1725
1726 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1727 continue;
1728
1729 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1730 continue;
1731
1732 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1733 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1734 {
1735 some_failed = 1;
1736 break;
1737 }
1738 if (some_failed)
1739 {
1740 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1741 if (loc->inserted)
1742 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1743
1744 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1745 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1746 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1747 bpt->number);
1748 error = -1;
1749 }
1750 }
1751
1752 if (error)
1753 {
1754 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1755 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1756 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1757 {
1758 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1759 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1760You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1761 }
1762 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1763 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1764 }
1765
1766 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1767}
1768
1769int
1770remove_breakpoints (void)
1771{
1772 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1773 int val = 0;
1774
1775 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1776 {
1777 if (b->inserted)
1778 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1779 }
1780 return val;
1781}
1782
1783/* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1784
1785int
1786remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1787{
1788 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1789 int val;
1790 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1791
1792 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1793 {
1794 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1795 continue;
1796
1797 if (b->inserted)
1798 {
1799 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1800 if (val != 0)
1801 return val;
1802 }
1803 }
1804 return 0;
1805}
1806
1807int
1808remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1809{
1810 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1811 int val = 0;
1812
1813 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1814 {
1815 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1816 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1817 }
1818 return val;
1819}
1820
1821int
1822reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1823{
1824 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1825 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1826 int val;
1827 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1828 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1829 struct inferior *inf;
1830 struct thread_info *tp;
1831
1832 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1833 if (tp == NULL)
1834 return 1;
1835
1836 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1837 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1838
1839 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1840
1841 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1842
1843 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1844 {
1845 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1846 continue;
1847
1848 if (b->inserted)
1849 {
1850 b->inserted = 0;
1851 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1852 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1853 if (val != 0)
1854 {
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 return val;
1857 }
1858 }
1859 }
1860 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1861 return 0;
1862}
1863
1864static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1865
1866static struct breakpoint *
1867create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1868 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1869{
1870 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1871 struct breakpoint *b;
1872
1873 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1874
1875 sal.pc = address;
1876 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1877 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1878
1879 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1880 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1881 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1882
1883 return b;
1884}
1885
1886static void
1887create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1888{
1889 struct objfile *objfile;
1890
1891 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1892 {
1893 struct breakpoint *b;
1894 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1895
1896 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1897 if (m == NULL)
1898 continue;
1899
1900 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1901 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1902 bp_overlay_event);
1903 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1904
1905 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1906 {
1907 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1908 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1909 }
1910 else
1911 {
1912 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1913 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1914 }
1915 }
1916 update_global_location_list (1);
1917}
1918
1919static void
1920create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1921{
1922 struct program_space *pspace;
1923 struct objfile *objfile;
1924 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1925
1926 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1927
1928 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1929 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1930 {
1931 struct breakpoint *b;
1932 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1933
1934 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1935 continue;
1936
1937 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1938
1939 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1940 if (m == NULL)
1941 continue;
1942
1943 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1944 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1945 bp_longjmp_master);
1946 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1947 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1948 }
1949 update_global_location_list (1);
1950
1951 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1952}
1953
1954void
1955update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1956{
1957 struct breakpoint *b;
1958 struct breakpoint *temp;
1959 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1960
1961 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1962 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1963 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1964 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1965 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1966 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1967 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1968 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1969 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1970 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1971 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1972
1973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1974 {
1975 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1976 continue;
1977
1978 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1979 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1980 {
1981 delete_breakpoint (b);
1982 continue;
1983 }
1984
1985 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1986 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1987 {
1988 delete_breakpoint (b);
1989 continue;
1990 }
1991
1992 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1993 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1994 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1995 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1996 {
1997 delete_breakpoint (b);
1998 continue;
1999 }
2000
2001 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2002 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2003 {
2004 delete_breakpoint (b);
2005 continue;
2006 }
2007
2008 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2009 after an exec. */
2010 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
2011 {
2012 delete_breakpoint (b);
2013 continue;
2014 }
2015
2016 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2017 {
2018 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2019 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2020 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2021 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2022 continue;
2023 }
2024
2025 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2026 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2027 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2028 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2029 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2030 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2031
2032 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2033 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2034 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2035 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2036 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2037 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2038 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2039
2040 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2041 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2042 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2043 let finish_command delete it.
2044
2045 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2046 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2047 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2048 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2049 solib breakpoints.) */
2050
2051 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2052 {
2053 continue;
2054 }
2055
2056 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2057 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2058 a.out. */
2059 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2060 {
2061 delete_breakpoint (b);
2062 continue;
2063 }
2064 }
2065 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2066 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2067 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2068 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2069 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2070 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2071}
2072
2073int
2074detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2075{
2076 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2077 int val = 0;
2078 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2079 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2080
2081 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2082 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2083
2084 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2085 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2086 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2087 {
2088 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2089 continue;
2090
2091 if (b->inserted)
2092 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2093 }
2094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2095 return val;
2096}
2097
2098/* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2099 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2100 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2101 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2102 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2103
2104static int
2105remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2106{
2107 int val;
2108 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2109
2110 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2111 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2112 return 0;
2113
2114 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2115 This should not ever happen. */
2116 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2117
2118 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2119 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2120 {
2121 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2122 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2123 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2124
2125 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2126 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2127 || b->section == NULL
2128 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2129 {
2130 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2131
2132 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2133 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2134 else
2135 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2136 }
2137 else
2138 {
2139 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2140 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2141 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2142 {
2143 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2144 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2145 */
2146 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2147 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2148 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2149 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2150 &b->overlay_target_info);
2151 else
2152 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2153 &b->overlay_target_info);
2154 }
2155 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2156 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2157 if (b->inserted)
2158 {
2159 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2160 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2161 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2162 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2163 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2164 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2165 &b->target_info);
2166
2167 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2168 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2169 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2170 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2171 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2172 &b->target_info);
2173 else
2174 val = 0;
2175 }
2176 else
2177 {
2178 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2179 val = 0;
2180 }
2181 }
2182
2183 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2184 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2185 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2186 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2187 val = 0;
2188
2189 if (val)
2190 return val;
2191 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2192 }
2193 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2194 {
2195 struct value *v;
2196 struct value *n;
2197
2198 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2199 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2200 b->watchpoint_type);
2201
2202 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2203 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2204 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2205 b->owner->number);
2206 }
2207 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2208 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2209 && !b->duplicate)
2210 {
2211 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2212
2213 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2214 if (val)
2215 return val;
2216 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2217 }
2218
2219 return 0;
2220}
2221
2222static int
2223remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2224{
2225 int ret;
2226 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2227
2228 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2229 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2230 return 0;
2231
2232 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2233 This should not ever happen. */
2234 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2235
2236 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2237
2238 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2239
2240 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2241
2242 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2243 return ret;
2244}
2245
2246/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2247
2248void
2249mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2250{
2251 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2252
2253 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2254 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2255 bpt->inserted = 0;
2256}
2257
2258/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2259 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2260
2261 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2262 between runs.
2263
2264 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2265 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2266 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2267
2268
2269
2270void
2271breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2272{
2273 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2274 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2275 int ix;
2276 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2277
2278 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2279 nothing to do. */
2280 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2281 return;
2282
2283 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2284 {
2285 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2286 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2287 bpt->inserted = 0;
2288 }
2289
2290 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2291 {
2292 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2293 continue;
2294
2295 switch (b->type)
2296 {
2297 case bp_call_dummy:
2298
2299 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2300 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2301 rid of it. */
2302
2303 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2304
2305 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2306
2307 case bp_shlib_event:
2308
2309 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2310 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2311 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2312 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2313 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2314
2315 (gdb) file prog-linux
2316 (gdb) run # native linux target
2317 ...
2318 (gdb) kill
2319 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2320 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2321 */
2322
2323 delete_breakpoint (b);
2324 break;
2325
2326 case bp_watchpoint:
2327 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2328 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2329 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2330
2331 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2332 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2333 delete_breakpoint (b);
2334 else if (context == inf_starting)
2335 {
2336 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2337 in insert_breakpoints. */
2338 if (b->val)
2339 value_free (b->val);
2340 b->val = NULL;
2341 b->val_valid = 0;
2342 }
2343 break;
2344 default:
2345 break;
2346 }
2347 }
2348
2349 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2350 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2351 free_bp_location (bpt);
2352 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2353}
2354
2355/* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2356 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2357 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2358 match, not program space. */
2359
2360/* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2361 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2362 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2363 permanent breakpoint.
2364 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2365 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2366 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2367 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2368 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2369
2370enum breakpoint_here
2371breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2372{
2373 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2374 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2375
2376 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2377 {
2378 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2379 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2380 continue;
2381
2382 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2383 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2384 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2385 aspace, pc))
2386 {
2387 if (overlay_debugging
2388 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2389 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2390 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2391 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2392 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2393 else
2394 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2395 }
2396 }
2397
2398 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2399}
2400
2401/* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2402
2403int
2404moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2405{
2406 struct bp_location *loc;
2407 int ix;
2408
2409 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2410 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2411 aspace, pc))
2412 return 1;
2413
2414 return 0;
2415}
2416
2417/* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2418 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2419 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2420 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2421
2422int
2423regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2424{
2425 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (bpt->inserted
2434 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2435 aspace, pc))
2436 {
2437 if (overlay_debugging
2438 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2439 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2440 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2441 else
2442 return 1;
2443 }
2444 }
2445 return 0;
2446}
2447
2448/* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2449 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2450
2451int
2452breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2453{
2454 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2455 return 1;
2456
2457 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2458 return 1;
2459
2460 return 0;
2461}
2462
2463/* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2464 inserted at PC. */
2465
2466int
2467software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2468{
2469 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2470 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2471
2472 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2473 {
2474 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2475 continue;
2476
2477 if (bpt->inserted
2478 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2479 aspace, pc))
2480 {
2481 if (overlay_debugging
2482 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2483 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2484 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2485 else
2486 return 1;
2487 }
2488 }
2489
2490 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2491 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2492 return 1;
2493
2494 return 0;
2495}
2496
2497int
2498hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2499 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2500{
2501 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2502
2503 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2504 {
2505 struct bp_location *loc;
2506
2507 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2508 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2509 continue;
2510
2511 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2512 continue;
2513
2514 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2515 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2516 {
2517 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2518
2519 /* Check for intersection. */
2520 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2521 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2522 if (l < h)
2523 return 1;
2524 }
2525 }
2526 return 0;
2527}
2528
2529/* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2530 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2531
2532int
2533breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2534 ptid_t ptid)
2535{
2536 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2537 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2538 int thread = -1;
2539 int task = 0;
2540
2541 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2542 {
2543 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2544 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2545 continue;
2546
2547 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2548 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2549 continue;
2550
2551 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2552 aspace, pc))
2553 continue;
2554
2555 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2556 {
2557 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2558 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2559 it is now time to do so. */
2560 if (thread == -1)
2561 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2562 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2563 continue;
2564 }
2565
2566 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2567 {
2568 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2569 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2570 it is now time to do so. */
2571 if (task == 0)
2572 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2573 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2574 continue;
2575 }
2576
2577 if (overlay_debugging
2578 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2579 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2580 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2581
2582 return 1;
2583 }
2584
2585 return 0;
2586}
2587\f
2588
2589/* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2590 in breakpoint.h. */
2591
2592int
2593ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2594{
2595 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2596}
2597
2598void
2599bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2600{
2601 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2602 value_free (bs->old_val);
2603 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2604 xfree (bs);
2605}
2606
2607/* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2608 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2609
2610void
2611bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2612{
2613 bpstat p;
2614 bpstat q;
2615
2616 if (bsp == 0)
2617 return;
2618 p = *bsp;
2619 while (p != NULL)
2620 {
2621 q = p->next;
2622 bpstat_free (p);
2623 p = q;
2624 }
2625 *bsp = NULL;
2626}
2627
2628/* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2629 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2630
2631bpstat
2632bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2633{
2634 bpstat p = NULL;
2635 bpstat tmp;
2636 bpstat retval = NULL;
2637
2638 if (bs == NULL)
2639 return bs;
2640
2641 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2642 {
2643 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2644 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2645 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2646 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2647 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2648 {
2649 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2650 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2651 }
2652
2653 if (p == NULL)
2654 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2655 retval = tmp;
2656 else
2657 p->next = tmp;
2658 p = tmp;
2659 }
2660 p->next = NULL;
2661 return retval;
2662}
2663
2664/* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2665
2666bpstat
2667bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2668{
2669 if (bsp == NULL)
2670 return NULL;
2671
2672 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2673 {
2674 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2675 return bsp;
2676 }
2677 return NULL;
2678}
2679
2680/* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2681 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2682 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2683
2684 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2685 step_resume breakpoint.
2686
2687 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2688struct breakpoint *
2689bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2690{
2691 int current_thread;
2692
2693 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2694
2695 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2696
2697 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2698 {
2699 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2700 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2701 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2702 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2703 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2704 }
2705
2706 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2707}
2708
2709
2710/* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2711 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2712 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2713 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2714 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2715 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2716 we set it.
2717 Return 1 otherwise. */
2718
2719int
2720bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2721{
2722 struct breakpoint *b;
2723
2724 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2725 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2726
2727 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2728 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2729 this function might return the same number more
2730 than once and this will look ugly. */
2731 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2732 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2733 if (b == NULL)
2734 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2735
2736 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2737 return 1;
2738}
2739
2740/* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2741
2742void
2743bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2744{
2745 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2746 {
2747 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2748 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2749 {
2750 value_free (bs->old_val);
2751 bs->old_val = NULL;
2752 }
2753 }
2754}
2755
2756/* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2757
2758static void
2759breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2760{
2761 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2762 {
2763 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2764
2765 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2766 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2767 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2768 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2769 if (tp->in_infcall)
2770 return;
2771 }
2772
2773 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2774}
2775
2776/* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2777static void
2778cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2779{
2780 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2781}
2782
2783/* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2784 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2785 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2786 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2787
2788 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2789 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2790 bpstat of the current thread. */
2791
2792static int
2793bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2794{
2795 bpstat bs;
2796 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2797 int again = 0;
2798
2799 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2800 in bs->commands. */
2801 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2802 return 0;
2803
2804 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2805 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2806
2807 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2808 bs = *bsp;
2809
2810 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2811 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2812 {
2813 struct command_line *cmd;
2814 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2815
2816 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2817
2818 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2819 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2820 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2821 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2822 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2823 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2824 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2825 the tree when we're done. */
2826 cmd = bs->commands;
2827 bs->commands = 0;
2828 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2829
2830 while (cmd != NULL)
2831 {
2832 execute_control_command (cmd);
2833
2834 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2835 break;
2836 else
2837 cmd = cmd->next;
2838 }
2839
2840 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2841 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2842
2843 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2844 {
2845 if (target_can_async_p ())
2846 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2847 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2848 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2849 ;
2850 else
2851 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2852 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2853 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2854 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2855 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2856 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2857 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2858 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2859 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2860 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2861 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2862 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2863 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2864 again = 1;
2865 break;
2866 }
2867 }
2868 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2869 return again;
2870}
2871
2872void
2873bpstat_do_actions (void)
2874{
2875 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2876 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2877 && target_has_execution
2878 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2879 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2880 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2881 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2882 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2883 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2884 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2885 break;
2886}
2887
2888/* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2889
2890static void
2891watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2892{
2893 if (val == NULL)
2894 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2895 else
2896 {
2897 struct value_print_options opts;
2898 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2899 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2900 }
2901}
2902
2903/* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2904 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2905 by having it set different print_it values.
2906
2907 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2908 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2909 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2910 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2911 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2912
2913 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2914 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2915 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2916 don't print anything else.
2917 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2918 that something to be followed by a location.
2919 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2920 that something to be followed by a location.
2921 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2922 analysis. */
2923
2924static enum print_stop_action
2925print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2926{
2927 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2928 struct breakpoint *b;
2929 const struct bp_location *bl;
2930 struct ui_stream *stb;
2931 int bp_temp = 0;
2932 enum print_stop_action result;
2933
2934 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2935 which has since been deleted. */
2936 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2937 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2938 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2939 b = bl->owner;
2940
2941 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2942 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2943
2944 switch (b->type)
2945 {
2946 case bp_breakpoint:
2947 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2948 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2949 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2950 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2951 bl->address,
2952 b->number, 1);
2953 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2954 if (bp_temp)
2955 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2956 else
2957 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2958 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2959 {
2960 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2961 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2962 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2963 }
2964 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2965 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2966 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2967 break;
2968
2969 case bp_shlib_event:
2970 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2971 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2972 to shlib event" message.) */
2973 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2974 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2975 break;
2976
2977 case bp_thread_event:
2978 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2979 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2980 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2981 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2982 break;
2983
2984 case bp_overlay_event:
2985 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2986 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2987 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2988 break;
2989
2990 case bp_longjmp_master:
2991 /* These should never be enabled. */
2992 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2993 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2994 break;
2995
2996 case bp_watchpoint:
2997 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2998 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2999 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3000 ui_out_field_string
3001 (uiout, "reason",
3002 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3003 mention (b);
3004 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3005 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3006 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3007 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3008 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3009 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3010 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3011 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3012 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3013 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3014 break;
3015
3016 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3017 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3018 ui_out_field_string
3019 (uiout, "reason",
3020 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3021 mention (b);
3022 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3023 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3024 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3025 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3026 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3027 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3028 break;
3029
3030 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3031 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3032 {
3033 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3034 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3035 ui_out_field_string
3036 (uiout, "reason",
3037 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3038 mention (b);
3039 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3040 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3041 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3042 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3043 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3044 }
3045 else
3046 {
3047 mention (b);
3048 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3049 ui_out_field_string
3050 (uiout, "reason",
3051 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3052 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3053 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3054 }
3055 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3056 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3057 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3058 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3059 break;
3060
3061 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3062 here. */
3063
3064 case bp_finish:
3065 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3066 ui_out_field_string
3067 (uiout, "reason",
3068 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3069 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3070 break;
3071
3072 case bp_until:
3073 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3074 ui_out_field_string
3075 (uiout, "reason",
3076 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3077 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3078 break;
3079
3080 case bp_none:
3081 case bp_longjmp:
3082 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3083 case bp_step_resume:
3084 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3085 case bp_call_dummy:
3086 case bp_tracepoint:
3087 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3088 case bp_jit_event:
3089 default:
3090 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3091 break;
3092 }
3093
3094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3095 return result;
3096}
3097
3098/* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3099 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3100 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3101 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3102 normal_stop(). */
3103
3104static enum print_stop_action
3105print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3106{
3107 switch (bs->print_it)
3108 {
3109 case print_it_noop:
3110 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3111 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3112 break;
3113
3114 case print_it_done:
3115 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3116 relevant messages. */
3117 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3118 break;
3119
3120 case print_it_normal:
3121 {
3122 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3123 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3124
3125 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3126 print_it_typical. */
3127 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3128 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3129 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3130 else
3131 return print_it_typical (bs);
3132 }
3133 break;
3134
3135 default:
3136 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3137 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3138 break;
3139 }
3140}
3141
3142/* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3143 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3144 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3145 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3146 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3147 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3148 routine is one of:
3149
3150 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3151 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3152 code to print the location. An example is
3153 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3154 the location.
3155 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3156 to also print the location part of the message.
3157 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3158 don't require a location appended to the end.
3159 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3160 further info to be printed.*/
3161
3162enum print_stop_action
3163bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3164{
3165 int val;
3166
3167 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3168 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3169 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3170 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3171 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3172 {
3173 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3174 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3175 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3176 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3177 return val;
3178 }
3179
3180 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3181 with and nothing was printed. */
3182 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3183}
3184
3185/* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3186 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3187 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3188 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3189
3190static int
3191breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3192{
3193 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3194 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3195 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3196 return i;
3197}
3198
3199/* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3200
3201static bpstat
3202bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3203{
3204 bpstat bs;
3205
3206 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3207 cbs->next = bs;
3208 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3209 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3210 bs->commands = NULL;
3211 bs->old_val = NULL;
3212 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3213 return bs;
3214}
3215\f
3216/* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3217 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3218
3219int
3220watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3221{
3222 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3223 CORE_ADDR addr;
3224 struct breakpoint *b;
3225
3226 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3227 {
3228 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3229 as not triggered. */
3230 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3231 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3232 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3233 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3234 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3235
3236 return 0;
3237 }
3238
3239 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3240 {
3241 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3242 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3243 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3244 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3245 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3246 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3247 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3248
3249 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3250 }
3251
3252 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3253 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3254 triggered. */
3255
3256 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3257 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3258 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3259 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3260 {
3261 struct bp_location *loc;
3262 struct value *v;
3263
3264 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3265 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3266 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3267 sufficient. */
3268 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3269 addr, loc->address,
3270 loc->length))
3271 {
3272 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3273 break;
3274 }
3275 }
3276
3277 return 1;
3278}
3279
3280/* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3281 because of check_errors). */
3282/* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3283#define WP_DELETED 1
3284/* The value has changed. */
3285#define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3286/* The value has not changed. */
3287#define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3288/* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3289#define WP_IGNORE 4
3290
3291#define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3292#define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3293
3294/* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3295
3296 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3297 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3298
3299static int
3300watchpoint_check (void *p)
3301{
3302 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3303 struct breakpoint *b;
3304 struct frame_info *fr;
3305 int within_current_scope;
3306
3307 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3308
3309 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3310 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3311 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3312 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3313 return WP_IGNORE;
3314
3315 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3316 within_current_scope = 1;
3317 else
3318 {
3319 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3320 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3321 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3322
3323 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3324 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3325 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3326 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3327 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3328 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3329 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3330 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3331 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3332 return WP_IGNORE;
3333
3334 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3335 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3336
3337 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3338 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3339 if (within_current_scope)
3340 {
3341 struct symbol *function;
3342
3343 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3344 if (function == NULL
3345 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3346 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3347 within_current_scope = 0;
3348 }
3349
3350 if (within_current_scope)
3351 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3352 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3353 the user. */
3354 select_frame (fr);
3355 }
3356
3357 if (within_current_scope)
3358 {
3359 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3360 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3361 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3362 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3363
3364 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3365 struct value *new_val;
3366
3367 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3368
3369 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3370 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3371 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3372 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3373 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3374 {
3375 if (new_val != NULL)
3376 {
3377 release_value (new_val);
3378 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3379 }
3380 bs->old_val = b->val;
3381 b->val = new_val;
3382 b->val_valid = 1;
3383 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3384 }
3385 else
3386 {
3387 /* Nothing changed. */
3388 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3389 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3390 }
3391 }
3392 else
3393 {
3394 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3395 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3396 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3397 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3398 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3399 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3400 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3401 the first value assigned). */
3402 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3403 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3404 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3405 information here. */
3406 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3407 ui_out_field_string
3408 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3409 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3410 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3411 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3412which its expression is valid.\n");
3413
3414 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3415 {
3416 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3417 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3418 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3419 }
3420 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3421
3422 return WP_DELETED;
3423 }
3424}
3425
3426/* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3427 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3428 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3429static int
3430bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3431 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3432{
3433 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3434
3435 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3436 tracepoints. */
3437 if (tracepoint_type (b))
3438 return 0;
3439
3440 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3441 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3442 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3443 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3444 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3445 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3446 {
3447 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3448 aspace, bp_addr))
3449 return 0;
3450 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3451 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3452 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3453 return 0;
3454 }
3455
3456 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3457 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3458 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3459 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3460 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3461 (did not match the data address). */
3462
3463 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3464 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3465 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3466 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3467 return 0;
3468
3469 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3470 {
3471 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3472 return 0;
3473 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3474 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3475 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3476 return 0;
3477 }
3478
3479 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3480 {
3481 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3482 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3483 return 0;
3484 }
3485
3486 return 1;
3487}
3488
3489/* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3490 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3491 to 0. */
3492static void
3493bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3494{
3495 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3496 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3497
3498 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3499 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3500 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3501 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3502 {
3503 CORE_ADDR addr;
3504 struct value *v;
3505 int must_check_value = 0;
3506
3507 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3508 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3509 watched value. */
3510 must_check_value = 1;
3511 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3512 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3513 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3514 this watchpoint. */
3515 must_check_value = 1;
3516 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3517 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3518 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3519 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3520 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3521 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3522 must_check_value = 1;
3523
3524 if (must_check_value)
3525 {
3526 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3527 b->number);
3528 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3529 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3530 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3531 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3532 switch (e)
3533 {
3534 case WP_DELETED:
3535 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3536 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3537 /* Stop. */
3538 break;
3539 case WP_IGNORE:
3540 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3541 bs->stop = 0;
3542 break;
3543 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3544 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3545 {
3546 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3547
3548 1. we're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3549 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3550 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3551 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3552 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3553 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3554 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3555 old value.
3556
3557 2. we're watching the triggered memory for both
3558 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3559 happen:
3560
3561 2.1. this is a target that can't break on data
3562 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3563 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3564 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3565
3566 2.2. otherwise, the target supports read
3567 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3568 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3569 watchpoint.
3570
3571 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3572 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3573 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3574 changes. This still gives false positives when
3575 the program writes the same value to memory as
3576 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3577 it for a read), but it's much better than
3578 nothing. */
3579
3580 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3581
3582 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3583 {
3584 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3585
3586 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3587 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3588 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3589 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3590 == watch_triggered_yes))
3591 {
3592 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3593 break;
3594 }
3595 }
3596
3597 if (other_write_watchpoint
3598 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3599 {
3600 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3601 and the value changed since the last time we
3602 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3603 Ignore it. */
3604 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3605 bs->stop = 0;
3606 }
3607 }
3608 break;
3609 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3610 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3611 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3612 {
3613 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3614 the value hasn't changed. */
3615 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3616 bs->stop = 0;
3617 }
3618 /* Stop. */
3619 break;
3620 default:
3621 /* Can't happen. */
3622 case 0:
3623 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3624 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3625 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3626 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3627 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3628 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3629 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3630 break;
3631 }
3632 }
3633 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3634 {
3635 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3636 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3637 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3638 anything for this watchpoint. */
3639 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3640 bs->stop = 0;
3641 }
3642 }
3643}
3644
3645
3646/* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3647 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3648 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3649static void
3650bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3651{
3652 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3653 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3654 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3655
3656 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3657 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3658 bs->stop = 0;
3659 else if (bs->stop)
3660 {
3661 int value_is_zero = 0;
3662 struct expression *cond;
3663
3664 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3665 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3666 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3667 iteration. */
3668 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3669 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3670
3671 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3672 cond = b->cond_exp;
3673 else
3674 cond = bl->cond;
3675
3676 if (cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3677 {
3678 int within_current_scope = 1;
3679
3680 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3681 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3682 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3683 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3684 function call. */
3685 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3686
3687 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3688 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3689 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3690 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3691 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3692 call site. */
3693 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
3694 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3695 else
3696 {
3697 struct frame_info *frame;
3698
3699 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
3700 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
3701 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
3702 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
3703 really matter which instantiation of the function
3704 where the condition makes sense triggers the
3705 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
3706 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
3707 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
3708 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
3709 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
3710 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
3711 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
3712 intuitive. */
3713 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
3714 if (frame != NULL)
3715 select_frame (frame);
3716 else
3717 within_current_scope = 0;
3718 }
3719 if (within_current_scope)
3720 value_is_zero
3721 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
3722 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3723 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3724 else
3725 {
3726 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
3727 "in the current scope"));
3728 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
3729 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
3730 value_is_zero = 0;
3731 }
3732 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3733 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3734 }
3735
3736 if (cond && value_is_zero)
3737 {
3738 bs->stop = 0;
3739 }
3740 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3741 {
3742 bs->stop = 0;
3743 }
3744 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3745 {
3746 b->ignore_count--;
3747 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3748 bs->stop = 0;
3749 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3750 stop. */
3751 ++(b->hit_count);
3752 }
3753 }
3754}
3755
3756
3757/* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3758 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3759
3760 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3761 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3762
3763 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3764
3765 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3766
3767 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3768 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3769 several reasons concurrently.)
3770
3771 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3772 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3773
3774bpstat
3775bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3776 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3777{
3778 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3779 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3780 struct bp_location *loc;
3781 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3782 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3783 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3784 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3785 int ix;
3786 int need_remove_insert;
3787
3788 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3789 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3790 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3791
3792 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3793 {
3794 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3795 continue;
3796
3797 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3798 {
3799 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3800 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3801 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3802 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3803 already. */
3804 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3805 break;
3806
3807 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3808 continue;
3809
3810 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3811 continue;
3812
3813 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3814
3815 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3816
3817 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3818 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3819 'stop' to 0. */
3820 bs->stop = 1;
3821 bs->print = 1;
3822
3823 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3824 if (!bs->stop)
3825 continue;
3826
3827 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3828 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3829 /* We do not stop for these. */
3830 bs->stop = 0;
3831 else
3832 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3833
3834 if (bs->stop)
3835 {
3836 ++(b->hit_count);
3837
3838 /* We will stop here */
3839 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3840 {
3841 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3842 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3843 update_global_location_list (0);
3844 }
3845 if (b->silent)
3846 bs->print = 0;
3847 bs->commands = b->commands;
3848 if (bs->commands
3849 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3850 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3851 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3852 {
3853 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3854 bs->print = 0;
3855 }
3856 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3857 }
3858
3859 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3860 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3861 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3862 }
3863 }
3864
3865 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3866 {
3867 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3868 aspace, bp_addr))
3869 {
3870 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3871 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3872 bs->stop = 0;
3873 bs->print = 0;
3874 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3875 }
3876 }
3877
3878 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3879
3880 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3881 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3882 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3883 done later. */
3884 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3885 if (bs->stop)
3886 break;
3887
3888 need_remove_insert = 0;
3889 if (bs == NULL)
3890 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3891 if (!bs->stop
3892 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3893 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3894 {
3895 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3896 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3897 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3898 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3899 need_remove_insert = 1;
3900 }
3901
3902 if (need_remove_insert)
3903 update_global_location_list (1);
3904
3905 return root_bs->next;
3906}
3907\f
3908/* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3909struct bpstat_what
3910bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3911{
3912 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3913 enum class
3914 {
3915 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3916 no_effect = 0,
3917
3918 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3919 wp_silent,
3920
3921 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3922 wp_noisy,
3923
3924 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3925 bp_nostop,
3926
3927 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3928 bp_silent,
3929
3930 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3931 bp_noisy,
3932
3933 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3934 long_jump,
3935
3936 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3937 long_resume,
3938
3939 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3940 step_resume,
3941
3942 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3943 shlib_event,
3944
3945 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3946 jit_event,
3947
3948 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3949 class_last
3950 };
3951
3952 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3953 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3954 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3955#define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3956#define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3957#define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3958#define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3959#define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3960#define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3961#define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3962#define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3963#define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3964
3965/* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3966 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3967 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3968#define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3969
3970 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3971 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3972 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3973 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3974 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3975 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3976 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3977
3978 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3979 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3980 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3981 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3982 ordering is:
3983
3984 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3985 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3986 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3987 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3988 ss < jit shl sn sr
3989 sn < jit shl sr
3990 jit < shl sr
3991 shl < sr
3992 sr <
3993
3994 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3995 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3996 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3997 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3998 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3999
4000 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
4001 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
4002 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
4003
4004 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
4005 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
4006 {
4007 /* old action */
4008 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
4009/* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
4010/* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4011/* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4012/* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
4013/* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4014/* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4015/* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
4016/* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
4017/* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
4018/* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
4019/* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
4020 };
4021
4022#undef kc
4023#undef ss
4024#undef sn
4025#undef sgl
4026#undef slr
4027#undef clr
4028#undef err
4029#undef sr
4030#undef ts
4031#undef shl
4032#undef jit
4033 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4034 struct bpstat_what retval;
4035
4036 retval.call_dummy = 0;
4037 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4038 {
4039 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
4040 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4041 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
4042 which has since been deleted. */
4043 continue;
4044 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
4045 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4046 else
4047 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
4048 {
4049 case bp_none:
4050 continue;
4051
4052 case bp_breakpoint:
4053 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4054 case bp_until:
4055 case bp_finish:
4056 if (bs->stop)
4057 {
4058 if (bs->print)
4059 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4060 else
4061 bs_class = bp_silent;
4062 }
4063 else
4064 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4065 break;
4066 case bp_watchpoint:
4067 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4068 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4069 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4070 if (bs->stop)
4071 {
4072 if (bs->print)
4073 bs_class = wp_noisy;
4074 else
4075 bs_class = wp_silent;
4076 }
4077 else
4078 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4079 This requires no further action. */
4080 bs_class = no_effect;
4081 break;
4082 case bp_longjmp:
4083 bs_class = long_jump;
4084 break;
4085 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4086 bs_class = long_resume;
4087 break;
4088 case bp_step_resume:
4089 if (bs->stop)
4090 {
4091 bs_class = step_resume;
4092 }
4093 else
4094 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4095 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4096 break;
4097 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4098 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4099 break;
4100 case bp_shlib_event:
4101 bs_class = shlib_event;
4102 break;
4103 case bp_jit_event:
4104 bs_class = jit_event;
4105 break;
4106 case bp_thread_event:
4107 case bp_overlay_event:
4108 case bp_longjmp_master:
4109 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4110 break;
4111 case bp_catchpoint:
4112 if (bs->stop)
4113 {
4114 if (bs->print)
4115 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4116 else
4117 bs_class = bp_silent;
4118 }
4119 else
4120 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4121 This requires no further action. */
4122 bs_class = no_effect;
4123 break;
4124 case bp_call_dummy:
4125 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4126 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4127 bs_class = bp_silent;
4128 retval.call_dummy = 1;
4129 break;
4130 case bp_tracepoint:
4131 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4132 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4133 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4134 out already. */
4135 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4136 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4137 break;
4138 }
4139 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
4140 }
4141 retval.main_action = current_action;
4142 return retval;
4143}
4144
4145/* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4146 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4147 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4148
4149int
4150bpstat_should_step (void)
4151{
4152 struct breakpoint *b;
4153 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4154 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4155 return 1;
4156 return 0;
4157}
4158
4159int
4160bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4161{
4162 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4163 if (bs->stop)
4164 return 1;
4165
4166 return 0;
4167}
4168
4169\f
4170
4171/* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4172
4173static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4174 struct bp_location *loc,
4175 char *wrap_indent,
4176 struct ui_stream *stb)
4177{
4178 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4179
4180 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4181 loc = NULL;
4182
4183 if (loc != NULL)
4184 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4185
4186 if (b->source_file && loc)
4187 {
4188 struct symbol *sym
4189 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4190 if (sym)
4191 {
4192 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4193 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4194 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4195 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4196 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4197 }
4198 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4199 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4200
4201 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4202 {
4203 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4204 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4205
4206 if (fullname)
4207 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4208 }
4209
4210 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4211 }
4212 else if (loc)
4213 {
4214 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4215 demangle, "");
4216 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4217 }
4218 else
4219 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4220
4221 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4222}
4223
4224/* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4225static void
4226print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4227 struct bp_location *loc,
4228 int loc_number,
4229 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4230 int print_address_bits,
4231 int allflag)
4232{
4233 struct command_line *l;
4234 struct symbol *sym;
4235 struct ep_type_description
4236 {
4237 enum bptype type;
4238 char *description;
4239 };
4240 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4241 {
4242 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4243 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4244 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4245 {bp_until, "until"},
4246 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4247 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4248 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4249 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4250 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4251 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4252 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4253 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4254 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4255 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4256 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4257 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4258 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4259 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4260 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4261 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4262 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4263 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4264 };
4265
4266 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4267 char wrap_indent[80];
4268 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4269 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4270 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4271
4272 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4273 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4274 struct value_print_options opts;
4275
4276 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4277
4278 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4279 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4280 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4281 location. */
4282 if (loc == NULL
4283 && (b->loc != NULL
4284 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4285 header_of_multiple = 1;
4286 if (loc == NULL)
4287 loc = b->loc;
4288
4289 annotate_record ();
4290 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4291
4292 /* 1 */
4293 annotate_field (0);
4294 if (part_of_multiple)
4295 {
4296 char *formatted;
4297 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4298 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4299 xfree (formatted);
4300 }
4301 else
4302 {
4303 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4304 }
4305
4306 /* 2 */
4307 annotate_field (1);
4308 if (part_of_multiple)
4309 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4310 else
4311 {
4312 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4313 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4314 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4315 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4316 (int) b->type);
4317 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4318 }
4319
4320 /* 3 */
4321 annotate_field (2);
4322 if (part_of_multiple)
4323 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4324 else
4325 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4326
4327
4328 /* 4 */
4329 annotate_field (3);
4330 if (part_of_multiple)
4331 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4332 else
4333 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4334 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4335 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4336
4337
4338 /* 5 and 6 */
4339 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4340 if (opts.addressprint)
4341 {
4342 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4343 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4344 else
4345 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4346 }
4347
4348 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4349 {
4350 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4351 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4352 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4353 just one location. */
4354 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4355 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4356 }
4357 else
4358 switch (b->type)
4359 {
4360 case bp_none:
4361 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4362 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4363 break;
4364
4365 case bp_watchpoint:
4366 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4367 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4368 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4369 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4370 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4371 is relatively readable). */
4372 if (opts.addressprint)
4373 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4374 annotate_field (5);
4375 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4376 break;
4377
4378 case bp_breakpoint:
4379 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4380 case bp_until:
4381 case bp_finish:
4382 case bp_longjmp:
4383 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4384 case bp_step_resume:
4385 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4386 case bp_call_dummy:
4387 case bp_shlib_event:
4388 case bp_thread_event:
4389 case bp_overlay_event:
4390 case bp_longjmp_master:
4391 case bp_tracepoint:
4392 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4393 case bp_jit_event:
4394 if (opts.addressprint)
4395 {
4396 annotate_field (4);
4397 if (header_of_multiple)
4398 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4399 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4400 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4401 else
4402 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4403 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4404 }
4405 annotate_field (5);
4406 if (!header_of_multiple)
4407 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4408 if (b->loc)
4409 *last_loc = b->loc;
4410 break;
4411 }
4412
4413
4414 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4415 are several. */
4416 if (loc != NULL
4417 && !header_of_multiple
4418 && (allflag
4419 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4420 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4421 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4422 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4423 {
4424 struct inferior *inf;
4425 int first = 1;
4426
4427 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4428 {
4429 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4430 {
4431 if (first)
4432 {
4433 first = 0;
4434 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4435 }
4436 else
4437 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4438 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4439 }
4440 }
4441 }
4442
4443 if (!part_of_multiple)
4444 {
4445 if (b->thread != -1)
4446 {
4447 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4448 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4449 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4450 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4451 }
4452 else if (b->task != 0)
4453 {
4454 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4455 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4456 }
4457 }
4458
4459 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4460
4461 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4462 {
4463 annotate_field (6);
4464 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4465 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4466 the frame ID. */
4467 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4468 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4469 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4470 }
4471
4472 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4473 {
4474 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4475 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4476 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4477 annotate_field (7);
4478 if (tracepoint_type (b))
4479 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4480 else
4481 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4482 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4483 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4484 }
4485
4486 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4487 {
4488 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4489 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4490 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4491 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4492 }
4493
4494 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4495 {
4496 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4497 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4498 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4499 else
4500 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4501 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4502 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4503 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4504 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4505 else
4506 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4507 }
4508
4509 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4510 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4511 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4512 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4513 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4514
4515 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4516 {
4517 annotate_field (8);
4518 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4519 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4520 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4521 }
4522
4523 l = b->commands;
4524 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4525 {
4526 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4527
4528 annotate_field (9);
4529 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4530 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4531 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4532 }
4533
4534 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4535 {
4536 annotate_field (10);
4537 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4538 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4539 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4540 }
4541
4542 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4543 {
4544 annotate_field (11);
4545 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4546 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4547 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4548 }
4549
4550 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4551 {
4552 struct action_line *action;
4553 annotate_field (12);
4554 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4555 {
4556 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4557 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4558 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4559 }
4560 }
4561
4562 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4563 {
4564 if (b->addr_string)
4565 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4566 else if (b->exp_string)
4567 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4568 }
4569
4570 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4571 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4572}
4573
4574static void
4575print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4576 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4577 int allflag)
4578{
4579 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4580 print_address_bits, allflag);
4581
4582 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4583 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4584 locations, if any. */
4585 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4586 {
4587 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4588 disabled, we print it as if it had
4589 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4590 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4591 situation.
4592 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4593 several locations internally, that's no a property
4594 exposed to user. */
4595 if (b->loc
4596 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4597 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4598 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4599 {
4600 struct bp_location *loc;
4601 int n = 1;
4602 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4603 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4604 print_address_bits, allflag);
4605 }
4606 }
4607}
4608
4609static int
4610breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4611{
4612 int print_address_bits = 0;
4613 struct bp_location *loc;
4614
4615 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4616 {
4617 int addr_bit;
4618
4619 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
4620 an address to print. */
4621 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
4622 continue;
4623
4624 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4625 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4626 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4627 }
4628
4629 return print_address_bits;
4630}
4631
4632struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4633 {
4634 int bnum;
4635 };
4636
4637static int
4638do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4639{
4640 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4641 struct breakpoint *b;
4642 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4644 {
4645 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4646 {
4647 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4648 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4649 return GDB_RC_OK;
4650 }
4651 }
4652 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4653}
4654
4655enum gdb_rc
4656gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4657{
4658 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4659 args.bnum = bnum;
4660 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4661 an error. */
4662 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4663 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4664 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4665 else
4666 return GDB_RC_OK;
4667}
4668
4669/* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4670 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4671
4672static int
4673user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4674{
4675 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4676 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4677 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4678 || tracepoint_type (b)
4679 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4680 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4681 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4682 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4683}
4684
4685/* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4686 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4687 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4688
4689static void
4690breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4691{
4692 struct breakpoint *b;
4693 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4694 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4695 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4696 struct value_print_options opts;
4697 int print_address_bits = 0;
4698
4699 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4700
4701 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4702 size required for address fields. */
4703 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4704 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4705 if (bnum == -1
4706 || bnum == b->number)
4707 {
4708 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4709 {
4710 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4711 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4712 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4713
4714 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4715 }
4716 }
4717
4718 if (opts.addressprint)
4719 bkpttbl_chain
4720 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4721 "BreakpointTable");
4722 else
4723 bkpttbl_chain
4724 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4725 "BreakpointTable");
4726
4727 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4728 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4729 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4730 annotate_field (0);
4731 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4732 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4733 annotate_field (1);
4734 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4735 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4736 annotate_field (2);
4737 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4738 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4739 annotate_field (3);
4740 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4741 if (opts.addressprint)
4742 {
4743 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4744 annotate_field (4);
4745 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4746 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4747 else
4748 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4749 }
4750 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4751 annotate_field (5);
4752 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4753 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4754 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4755 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4756
4757 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4758 {
4759 QUIT;
4760 if (bnum == -1
4761 || bnum == b->number)
4762 {
4763 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4764 allflag is set. */
4765 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4766 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4767 }
4768 }
4769
4770 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4771
4772 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4773 {
4774 if (bnum == -1)
4775 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4776 else
4777 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4778 bnum);
4779 }
4780 else
4781 {
4782 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4783 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4784 }
4785
4786 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4787 there have been breakpoints? */
4788 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4789}
4790
4791static void
4792breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4793{
4794 int bnum = -1;
4795
4796 if (bnum_exp)
4797 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4798
4799 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4800}
4801
4802static void
4803maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4804{
4805 int bnum = -1;
4806
4807 if (bnum_exp)
4808 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4809
4810 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4811}
4812
4813static int
4814breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4815 struct program_space *pspace,
4816 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4817{
4818 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4819 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4820 {
4821 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4822 && bl->address == pc
4823 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4824 return 1;
4825 }
4826 return 0;
4827}
4828
4829/* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4830 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4831 address spaces. */
4832
4833static void
4834describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4835 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4836 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4837{
4838 int others = 0;
4839 struct breakpoint *b;
4840
4841 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4842 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4843 if (others > 0)
4844 {
4845 if (others == 1)
4846 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4847 else /* if (others == ???) */
4848 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4849 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4850 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4851 {
4852 others--;
4853 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4854 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4855 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4856 else if (b->thread != -1)
4857 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4858 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4859 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4860 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4861 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4862 ? " (disabled)"
4863 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4864 ? " (permanent)"
4865 : ""),
4866 (others > 1) ? ","
4867 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4868 }
4869 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4870 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4871 printf_filtered (".\n");
4872 }
4873}
4874\f
4875/* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4876 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4877
4878void
4879set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4880 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4881 int line)
4882{
4883 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4884 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4885 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4886 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4887 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4888}
4889
4890/* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4891 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4892 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4893 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4894
4895 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4896 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4897 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4898
4899 bp_watchpoint
4900 bp_catchpoint
4901
4902*/
4903
4904static int
4905breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4906{
4907 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4908
4909 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4910}
4911
4912/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4913 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4914
4915static int
4916watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4917{
4918 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
4919 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
4920 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
4921 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
4922 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
4923 become hw_access locations later. */
4924 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4925 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4926 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4927 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4928}
4929
4930/* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4931 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4932 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4933 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4934
4935static int
4936breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4937 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4938{
4939 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4940 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4941 && addr1 == addr2);
4942}
4943
4944/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4945 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4946 represent the same location. */
4947
4948static int
4949breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4950{
4951 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4952 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4953
4954 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4955 return 0;
4956 else if (hw_point1)
4957 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4958 else
4959 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4960 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4961}
4962
4963static void
4964breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4965 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4966{
4967 char astr1[40];
4968 char astr2[40];
4969
4970 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4971 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4972 if (have_bnum)
4973 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4974 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4975 else
4976 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4977}
4978
4979/* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4980 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4981 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4982 this function is simply the identity function. */
4983
4984static CORE_ADDR
4985adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4986 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4987{
4988 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4989 {
4990 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4991 return bpaddr;
4992 }
4993 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4994 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4995 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4996 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4997 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4998 {
4999 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5000 have their addresses modified. */
5001 return bpaddr;
5002 }
5003 else
5004 {
5005 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5006
5007 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5008 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5009 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5010
5011 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5012 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5013 is required. */
5014 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5015 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5016
5017 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5018 }
5019}
5020
5021/* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5022
5023static struct bp_location *
5024allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5025{
5026 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
5027
5028 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5029 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5030
5031 loc->owner = bpt;
5032 loc->cond = NULL;
5033 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5034 loc->enabled = 1;
5035
5036 switch (bpt->type)
5037 {
5038 case bp_breakpoint:
5039 case bp_until:
5040 case bp_finish:
5041 case bp_longjmp:
5042 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5043 case bp_step_resume:
5044 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5045 case bp_call_dummy:
5046 case bp_shlib_event:
5047 case bp_thread_event:
5048 case bp_overlay_event:
5049 case bp_jit_event:
5050 case bp_longjmp_master:
5051 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5052 break;
5053 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5054 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5055 break;
5056 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5057 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5058 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5059 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5060 break;
5061 case bp_watchpoint:
5062 case bp_catchpoint:
5063 case bp_tracepoint:
5064 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5065 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5066 break;
5067 default:
5068 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5069 }
5070
5071 return loc;
5072}
5073
5074static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5075{
5076 if (loc->cond)
5077 xfree (loc->cond);
5078
5079 if (loc->function_name)
5080 xfree (loc->function_name);
5081
5082 xfree (loc);
5083}
5084
5085/* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
5086 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5087/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
5088
5089static struct breakpoint *
5090set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5091 enum bptype bptype)
5092{
5093 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5094
5095 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5096 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5097
5098 b->type = bptype;
5099 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5100 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5101 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5102 b->thread = -1;
5103 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5104 b->next = 0;
5105 b->silent = 0;
5106 b->ignore_count = 0;
5107 b->commands = NULL;
5108 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5109 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5110 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5111 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5112 b->ops = NULL;
5113 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5114
5115 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
5116 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
5117 of increasing numbers. */
5118
5119 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5120 if (b1 == 0)
5121 breakpoint_chain = b;
5122 else
5123 {
5124 while (b1->next)
5125 b1 = b1->next;
5126 b1->next = b;
5127 }
5128 return b;
5129}
5130
5131/* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5132static void
5133set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5134{
5135 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5136 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5137 || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
5138 {
5139 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5140 NULL, NULL);
5141 if (loc->function_name)
5142 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5143 }
5144}
5145
5146/* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5147static struct gdbarch *
5148get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5149{
5150 if (sal.section)
5151 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5152 if (sal.symtab)
5153 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5154
5155 return NULL;
5156}
5157
5158/* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5159 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5160 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5161 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5162 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5163 is also returned as the value of this function.
5164
5165 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5166 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5167 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5168 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5169 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5170 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5171 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5172
5173struct breakpoint *
5174set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5175 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5176{
5177 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
5178 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5179 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5180
5181 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5182 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5183 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5184
5185 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5186 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5187
5188 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5189 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5190 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5191 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5192 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5193 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5194 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
5195
5196 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5197 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5198 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5199 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5200 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5201
5202 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5203 breakpoint resetting. */
5204 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5205
5206 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5207 b->source_file = NULL;
5208 else
5209 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5210 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5211 b->line_number = sal.line;
5212
5213 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5214
5215 breakpoints_changed ();
5216
5217 return b;
5218}
5219
5220
5221/* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5222 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5223void
5224make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5225{
5226 struct bp_location *bl;
5227 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5228
5229 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5230 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5231 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5232 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5233 but it's easy to implmement. */
5234 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5235 bl->inserted = 1;
5236}
5237
5238/* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5239 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5240 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5241
5242void
5243set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5244{
5245 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5246
5247 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5248 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5249 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5250 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5251 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5252 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5253 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5254 {
5255 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5256 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5257 clone->thread = thread;
5258 }
5259}
5260
5261/* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5262void
5263delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5264{
5265 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5266
5267 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5268 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5269 {
5270 if (b->thread == thread)
5271 delete_breakpoint (b);
5272 }
5273}
5274
5275void
5276enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5277{
5278 struct breakpoint *b;
5279
5280 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5281 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5282 {
5283 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5284 update_global_location_list (1);
5285 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5286 }
5287}
5288
5289void
5290disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5291{
5292 struct breakpoint *b;
5293
5294 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5295 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5296 {
5297 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5298 update_global_location_list (0);
5299 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5300 }
5301}
5302
5303struct breakpoint *
5304create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5305{
5306 struct breakpoint *b;
5307
5308 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5309
5310 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5311 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5312 b->addr_string
5313 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5314
5315 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5316
5317 return b;
5318}
5319
5320void
5321remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5322{
5323 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5324
5325 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5326 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5327 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5328 delete_breakpoint (b);
5329}
5330
5331struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5332 {
5333 char **arg_p;
5334 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5335 char ***addr_string_p;
5336 int *not_found_ptr;
5337 };
5338
5339struct lang_and_radix
5340 {
5341 enum language lang;
5342 int radix;
5343 };
5344
5345/* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5346
5347struct breakpoint *
5348create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5349{
5350 struct breakpoint *b;
5351
5352 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5353 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5354 return b;
5355}
5356
5357void
5358remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5359{
5360 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5361
5362 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5363 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5364 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5365 delete_breakpoint (b);
5366}
5367
5368struct breakpoint *
5369create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5370{
5371 struct breakpoint *b;
5372
5373 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5374 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5375 return b;
5376}
5377
5378/* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5379 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5380
5381void
5382disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5383{
5384 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5385
5386 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5387 {
5388 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5389 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5390 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5391 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5392 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5393 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5394 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5395 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
5396 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5397 || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5398 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5399 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5400#ifdef PC_SOLIB
5401 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5402#else
5403 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5404#endif
5405 )
5406 {
5407 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5408 }
5409 }
5410}
5411
5412/* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5413 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5414
5415static void
5416disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5417{
5418 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5419 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5420
5421 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5422 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5423 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5424 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5425 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5426 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5427 return;
5428
5429 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5430 {
5431 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5432 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5433 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5434 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5435 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5436 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5437 || b->type == bp_jit_event
5438 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5439 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5440 {
5441 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5442 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5443 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5444 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5445 loc->inserted = 0;
5446 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5447 {
5448 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5449 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5450 solib->so_name);
5451 }
5452 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5453 }
5454 }
5455}
5456
5457/* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5458
5459/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5460
5461static void
5462insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5463{
5464 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5465}
5466
5467/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5468
5469static int
5470remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5471{
5472 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5473}
5474
5475/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5476 catchpoints. */
5477
5478static int
5479breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5480{
5481 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5482}
5483
5484/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5485
5486static enum print_stop_action
5487print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5488{
5489 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5490 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5491 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5492 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5493}
5494
5495/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5496
5497static void
5498print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5499{
5500 struct value_print_options opts;
5501
5502 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5503
5504 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5505 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5506 is relatively readable). */
5507 if (opts.addressprint)
5508 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5509 annotate_field (5);
5510 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5511 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5512 {
5513 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5514 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5515 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5516 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5517 }
5518}
5519
5520/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5521 catchpoints. */
5522
5523static void
5524print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5525{
5526 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5527}
5528
5529/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5530
5531static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5532{
5533 insert_catch_fork,
5534 remove_catch_fork,
5535 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5536 print_it_catch_fork,
5537 print_one_catch_fork,
5538 print_mention_catch_fork
5539};
5540
5541/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5542
5543static void
5544insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5545{
5546 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5547}
5548
5549/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5550
5551static int
5552remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5553{
5554 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5555}
5556
5557/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5558 catchpoints. */
5559
5560static int
5561breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5562{
5563 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5564}
5565
5566/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5567
5568static enum print_stop_action
5569print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5570{
5571 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5572 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5573 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5574 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5575}
5576
5577/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5578
5579static void
5580print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5581{
5582 struct value_print_options opts;
5583
5584 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5585 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5586 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5587 is relatively readable). */
5588 if (opts.addressprint)
5589 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5590 annotate_field (5);
5591 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5592 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5593 {
5594 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5595 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5596 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5597 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5598 }
5599}
5600
5601/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5602 catchpoints. */
5603
5604static void
5605print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5606{
5607 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5608}
5609
5610/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5611
5612static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5613{
5614 insert_catch_vfork,
5615 remove_catch_vfork,
5616 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5617 print_it_catch_vfork,
5618 print_one_catch_vfork,
5619 print_mention_catch_vfork
5620};
5621
5622/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5623 catchpoints. */
5624
5625static void
5626insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5627{
5628 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5629
5630 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5631 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5632 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5633 else
5634 {
5635 int i, iter;
5636 for (i = 0;
5637 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5638 i++)
5639 {
5640 int elem;
5641 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5642 {
5643 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5644 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5645 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5646 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5647 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5648 vec_addr_offset;
5649 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5650 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5651 }
5652 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5653 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5654 }
5655 }
5656
5657 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5658 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5659 inf->any_syscall_count,
5660 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5661 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5662}
5663
5664/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5665 catchpoints. */
5666
5667static int
5668remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5669{
5670 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5671
5672 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5673 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5674 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5675 else
5676 {
5677 int i, iter;
5678 for (i = 0;
5679 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5680 i++)
5681 {
5682 int elem;
5683 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5684 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5685 continue;
5686 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5687 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5688 }
5689 }
5690
5691 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5692 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5693 inf->any_syscall_count,
5694 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5695 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5696}
5697
5698/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5699 catchpoints. */
5700
5701static int
5702breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5703{
5704 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5705 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5706 syscall we are catching. */
5707 int syscall_number = 0;
5708
5709 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5710 return 0;
5711
5712 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5713 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5714 {
5715 int i, iter;
5716 for (i = 0;
5717 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5718 i++)
5719 if (syscall_number == iter)
5720 break;
5721 /* Not the same. */
5722 if (!iter)
5723 return 0;
5724 }
5725
5726 return 1;
5727}
5728
5729/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5730 catchpoints. */
5731
5732static enum print_stop_action
5733print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5734{
5735 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5736 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5737 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5738 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5739 ptid_t ptid;
5740 struct target_waitstatus last;
5741 struct syscall s;
5742 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5743 char *syscall_id;
5744
5745 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5746
5747 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5748
5749 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5750
5751 if (s.name == NULL)
5752 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5753 else
5754 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5755
5756 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5757
5758 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5759 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5760 b->number, syscall_id);
5761 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5762 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5763 b->number, syscall_id);
5764
5765 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5766
5767 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5768}
5769
5770/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5771 catchpoints. */
5772
5773static void
5774print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5775 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5776{
5777 struct value_print_options opts;
5778
5779 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5780 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5781 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5782 is relatively readable). */
5783 if (opts.addressprint)
5784 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5785 annotate_field (5);
5786
5787 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5788 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5789 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5790 else
5791 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5792
5793 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5794 {
5795 int i, iter;
5796 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5797 for (i = 0;
5798 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5799 i++)
5800 {
5801 char *x = text;
5802 struct syscall s;
5803 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5804
5805 if (s.name != NULL)
5806 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5807 else
5808 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5809
5810 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5811 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5812 on every call. */
5813 xfree (x);
5814 }
5815 /* Remove the last comma. */
5816 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5817 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5818 }
5819 else
5820 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5821 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5822}
5823
5824/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5825 catchpoints. */
5826
5827static void
5828print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5829{
5830 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5831 {
5832 int i, iter;
5833
5834 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5835 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5836 else
5837 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5838
5839 for (i = 0;
5840 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5841 i++)
5842 {
5843 struct syscall s;
5844 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5845
5846 if (s.name)
5847 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5848 else
5849 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5850 }
5851 printf_filtered (")");
5852 }
5853 else
5854 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5855 b->number);
5856}
5857
5858/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5859
5860static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5861{
5862 insert_catch_syscall,
5863 remove_catch_syscall,
5864 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5865 print_it_catch_syscall,
5866 print_one_catch_syscall,
5867 print_mention_catch_syscall
5868};
5869
5870/* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5871
5872static int
5873syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5874{
5875 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5876}
5877
5878/* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5879 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5880 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5881 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5882
5883 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5884 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5885 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5886 to the catchpoint. */
5887
5888static struct breakpoint *
5889create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5890 char *cond_string,
5891 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5892{
5893 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5894 struct breakpoint *b;
5895
5896 init_sal (&sal);
5897 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5898
5899 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5900 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5901 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5902
5903 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5904 b->thread = -1;
5905 b->addr_string = NULL;
5906 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5907 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5908 b->ops = ops;
5909
5910 return b;
5911}
5912
5913/* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5914
5915 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5916 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5917 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5918 to the catchpoint. */
5919
5920static struct breakpoint *
5921create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5922 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5923{
5924 struct breakpoint *b =
5925 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5926
5927 mention (b);
5928 update_global_location_list (1);
5929
5930 return b;
5931}
5932
5933static void
5934create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5935 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5936 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5937{
5938 struct breakpoint *b
5939 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5940
5941 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5942 area. */
5943 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5944}
5945
5946/* Exec catchpoints. */
5947
5948static void
5949insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5950{
5951 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5952}
5953
5954static int
5955remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5956{
5957 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5958}
5959
5960static int
5961breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5962{
5963 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5964}
5965
5966static enum print_stop_action
5967print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5968{
5969 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5970 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5971 b->exec_pathname);
5972 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5973}
5974
5975static void
5976print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5977{
5978 struct value_print_options opts;
5979
5980 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5981
5982 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5983 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5984 is relatively readable). */
5985 if (opts.addressprint)
5986 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5987 annotate_field (5);
5988 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5989 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5990 {
5991 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5992 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5993 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5994 }
5995}
5996
5997static void
5998print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5999{
6000 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
6001}
6002
6003static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6004{
6005 insert_catch_exec,
6006 remove_catch_exec,
6007 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6008 print_it_catch_exec,
6009 print_one_catch_exec,
6010 print_mention_catch_exec
6011};
6012
6013static void
6014create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6015 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6016{
6017 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6018 struct breakpoint *b =
6019 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6020
6021 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6022
6023 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6024 location list. */
6025 mention (b);
6026 update_global_location_list (1);
6027}
6028
6029static int
6030hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6031{
6032 struct breakpoint *b;
6033 int i = 0;
6034
6035 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6036 {
6037 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6038 i++;
6039 }
6040
6041 return i;
6042}
6043
6044static int
6045hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6046{
6047 struct breakpoint *b;
6048 int i = 0;
6049
6050 *other_type_used = 0;
6051 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6052 {
6053 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
6054 {
6055 if (b->type == type)
6056 i++;
6057 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6058 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
6059 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6060 *other_type_used = 1;
6061 }
6062 }
6063 return i;
6064}
6065
6066void
6067disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6068{
6069 struct breakpoint *b;
6070
6071 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6072 {
6073 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6074 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6075 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6076 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6077 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6078 {
6079 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6080 update_global_location_list (0);
6081 }
6082 }
6083}
6084
6085void
6086enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6087{
6088 struct breakpoint *b;
6089
6090 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6091 {
6092 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6093 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6094 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6095 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6096 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
6097 {
6098 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6099 update_global_location_list (1);
6100 }
6101 }
6102}
6103
6104void
6105disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6106{
6107 struct breakpoint *b;
6108 int found = 0;
6109
6110 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6111 {
6112 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6113 continue;
6114
6115 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6116 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6117 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6118 {
6119 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6120 found = 1;
6121 }
6122 }
6123
6124 if (found)
6125 update_global_location_list (0);
6126
6127 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6128}
6129
6130void
6131enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6132{
6133 struct breakpoint *b;
6134 int found = 0;
6135
6136 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6137
6138 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6139 {
6140 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6141 continue;
6142
6143 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6144 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6145 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6146 {
6147 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6148 found = 1;
6149 }
6150 }
6151
6152 if (found)
6153 breakpoint_re_set ();
6154}
6155
6156
6157/* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6158 at address specified by SAL.
6159 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6160
6161struct breakpoint *
6162set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6163 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6164{
6165 struct breakpoint *b;
6166
6167 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6168 one. */
6169 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6170
6171 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6172 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6173 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6174 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6175
6176 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
6177 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
6178 single thread of control. */
6179 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6180 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6181
6182 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6183
6184 return b;
6185}
6186
6187/* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6188 ORIG is NULL. */
6189
6190struct breakpoint *
6191clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6192{
6193 struct breakpoint *copy;
6194
6195 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6196 if (orig == NULL)
6197 return NULL;
6198
6199 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6200 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6201 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6202
6203 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6204 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6205 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6206 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6207 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6208
6209 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6210 copy->source_file = NULL;
6211 else
6212 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6213
6214 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6215 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6216 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6217 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6218
6219 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6220 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6221 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6222
6223 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6224 return copy;
6225}
6226
6227struct breakpoint *
6228set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6229 enum bptype type)
6230{
6231 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6232
6233 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6234 sal.pc = pc;
6235 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6236 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6237
6238 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6239}
6240\f
6241
6242/* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6243
6244static void
6245mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6246{
6247 int say_where = 0;
6248 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6249 struct value_print_options opts;
6250
6251 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6252
6253 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6254 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6255 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6256 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6257 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6258
6259 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6260 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6261 else
6262 switch (b->type)
6263 {
6264 case bp_none:
6265 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6266 break;
6267 case bp_watchpoint:
6268 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6269 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6270 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6271 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6272 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6273 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6274 break;
6275 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6276 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6277 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6278 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6279 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6280 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6281 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6282 break;
6283 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6284 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6285 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6286 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6287 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6288 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6289 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6290 break;
6291 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6292 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6293 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6294 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6295 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6296 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6297 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6298 break;
6299 case bp_breakpoint:
6300 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6301 {
6302 say_where = 0;
6303 break;
6304 }
6305 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6306 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6307 else
6308 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6309 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6310 say_where = 1;
6311 break;
6312 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6313 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6314 {
6315 say_where = 0;
6316 break;
6317 }
6318 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6319 say_where = 1;
6320 break;
6321 case bp_tracepoint:
6322 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6323 {
6324 say_where = 0;
6325 break;
6326 }
6327 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6328 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6329 say_where = 1;
6330 break;
6331 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6332 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6333 {
6334 say_where = 0;
6335 break;
6336 }
6337 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6338 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6339 say_where = 1;
6340 break;
6341
6342 case bp_until:
6343 case bp_finish:
6344 case bp_longjmp:
6345 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6346 case bp_step_resume:
6347 case bp_call_dummy:
6348 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6349 case bp_shlib_event:
6350 case bp_thread_event:
6351 case bp_overlay_event:
6352 case bp_jit_event:
6353 case bp_longjmp_master:
6354 break;
6355 }
6356
6357 if (say_where)
6358 {
6359 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6360 single string. */
6361 if (b->loc == NULL)
6362 {
6363 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6364 }
6365 else
6366 {
6367 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6368 {
6369 printf_filtered (" at ");
6370 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6371 gdb_stdout);
6372 }
6373 if (b->source_file)
6374 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6375 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6376
6377 if (b->loc->next)
6378 {
6379 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6380 int n = 0;
6381 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6382 ++n;
6383 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6384 }
6385
6386 }
6387 }
6388 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6389 return;
6390 printf_filtered ("\n");
6391}
6392\f
6393
6394static struct bp_location *
6395add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6396 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6397{
6398 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6399
6400 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6401 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6402 ;
6403 *tmp = loc;
6404 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6405 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6406 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6407 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6408 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6409 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6410 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6411 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6412 loc->section = sal->section;
6413
6414 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6415 return loc;
6416}
6417\f
6418
6419/* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6420 return 0 otherwise. */
6421
6422static int
6423bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6424{
6425 int len;
6426 CORE_ADDR addr;
6427 const gdb_byte *brk;
6428 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6429 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6430 int retval = 0;
6431
6432 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6433
6434 addr = loc->address;
6435 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6436
6437 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6438 if (brk == NULL)
6439 return 0;
6440
6441 target_mem = alloca (len);
6442
6443 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6444 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6445 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6446 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6447
6448 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6449 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6450
6451 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6452 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6453 retval = 1;
6454
6455 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6456
6457 return retval;
6458}
6459
6460
6461
6462/* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6463 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6464 as condition expression. */
6465
6466static void
6467create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6468 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6469 char *cond_string,
6470 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6471 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6472 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6473{
6474 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6475 int i;
6476
6477 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6478 {
6479 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6480 int target_resources_ok =
6481 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6482 i + 1, 0);
6483 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6484 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6485 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6486 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6487 }
6488
6489 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6490
6491 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6492 {
6493 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6494 struct bp_location *loc;
6495
6496 if (from_tty)
6497 {
6498 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6499 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6500 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6501
6502 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6503 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6504 }
6505
6506 if (i == 0)
6507 {
6508 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6509 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6510 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6511 b->thread = thread;
6512 b->task = task;
6513
6514 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6515 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6516 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6517 b->disposition = disposition;
6518
6519 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6520
6521 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6522 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6523 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6524 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6525
6526 loc = b->loc;
6527 }
6528 else
6529 {
6530 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6531 }
6532
6533 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6534 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6535
6536 if (b->cond_string)
6537 {
6538 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6539 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6540 if (*arg)
6541 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6542 }
6543 }
6544
6545 if (addr_string)
6546 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6547 else
6548 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6549 me. */
6550 b->addr_string
6551 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6552
6553 b->ops = ops;
6554 mention (b);
6555}
6556
6557/* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6558 elements to fill the void space. */
6559static void
6560remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6561{
6562 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6563 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6564
6565 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6566 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6567
6568 --(sal->nelts);
6569}
6570
6571/* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6572 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6573 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6574 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6575 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6576 single expanded sal, return the original.
6577
6578 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6579 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6580 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6581 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6582 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6583
6584static struct symtabs_and_lines
6585expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6586{
6587 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6588 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6589 char *original_function = NULL;
6590 int found;
6591 int i;
6592 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6593
6594 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6595 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6596 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6597 {
6598 expanded.nelts = 1;
6599 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6600 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6601 return expanded;
6602 }
6603
6604 sal.pc = 0;
6605
6606 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6607
6608 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6609
6610 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6611
6612 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6613 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6614
6615 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6616 {
6617 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6618 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6619 xfree (expanded.sals);
6620 expanded.nelts = 1;
6621 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6622 sal.pc = original_pc;
6623 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6624 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6625 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6626 return expanded;
6627 }
6628
6629 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6630 {
6631 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6632 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6633 {
6634 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6635 char *this_function;
6636
6637 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6638 read memory. */
6639 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6640
6641 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6642 &func_addr, &func_end))
6643 {
6644 if (this_function
6645 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6646 {
6647 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6648 --i;
6649 }
6650 else if (func_addr == pc)
6651 {
6652 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6653 skip prologue. */
6654 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6655 if (sym)
6656 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6657 else
6658 {
6659 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6660 we should really always find the section here. */
6661 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6662 if (section)
6663 {
6664 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6665 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6666 expanded.sals[i].pc
6667 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6668 }
6669 }
6670 }
6671 }
6672 }
6673 }
6674 else
6675 {
6676 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6677 {
6678 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6679 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6680 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6681 }
6682 }
6683
6684 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6685
6686 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6687 {
6688 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6689 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6690 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6691 xfree (expanded.sals);
6692 expanded.nelts = 1;
6693 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6694 sal.pc = original_pc;
6695 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6696 return expanded;
6697 }
6698
6699 if (original_pc)
6700 {
6701 found = 0;
6702 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6703 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6704 {
6705 found = 1;
6706 break;
6707 }
6708 gdb_assert (found);
6709 }
6710
6711 return expanded;
6712}
6713
6714/* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6715 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6716 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6717 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6718 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6719 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6720 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6721 we take just a single condition string.
6722
6723 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6724 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6725 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6726 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6727 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6728
6729static void
6730create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6731 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6732 char *cond_string,
6733 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6734 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6735 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6736 int enabled)
6737{
6738 int i;
6739 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6740 {
6741 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6742 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6743
6744 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6745 cond_string, type, disposition,
6746 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6747 }
6748}
6749
6750/* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6751 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6752 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6753 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6754
6755static void
6756parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6757 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6758 char ***addr_string,
6759 int *not_found_ptr)
6760{
6761 char *addr_start = *address;
6762 *addr_string = NULL;
6763 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6764 breakpoint. */
6765 if ((*address) == NULL
6766 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6767 {
6768 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6769 {
6770 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6771 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6772 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6773 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6774 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6775 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6776 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6777 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6778 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6779
6780 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6781 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6782 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6783 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6784 */
6785 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6786
6787 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6788 sals->nelts = 1;
6789 }
6790 else
6791 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6792 }
6793 else
6794 {
6795 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6796 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6797 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6798 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6799 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6800 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6801
6802 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6803
6804 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6805 && (!cursal.symtab
6806 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6807 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6808 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6809 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6810 not_found_ptr);
6811 else
6812 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6813 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6814 }
6815 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6816 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6817 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6818 if (addr_start != (*address))
6819 {
6820 int i;
6821 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6822 {
6823 /* Add the string if not present. */
6824 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6825 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6826 }
6827 }
6828}
6829
6830
6831/* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6832 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6833
6834static void
6835breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6836 char *address)
6837{
6838 int i;
6839 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6840 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6841}
6842
6843/* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
6844 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6845 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6846 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6847 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6848 it, etc. */
6849
6850static void
6851check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6852 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6853{
6854 int i, rslt;
6855 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6856 char *msg;
6857 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6858
6859 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6860 {
6861 sal = &sals->sals[i];
6862
6863 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6864 NULL, &msg);
6865 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6866
6867 if (!rslt)
6868 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6869 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6870
6871 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6872 }
6873}
6874
6875static void
6876do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6877{
6878 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6879
6880 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6881 args->not_found_ptr);
6882}
6883
6884/* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6885 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6886 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6887 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6888 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6889 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6890static void
6891find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6892 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6893{
6894 *cond_string = NULL;
6895 *thread = -1;
6896 while (tok && *tok)
6897 {
6898 char *end_tok;
6899 int toklen;
6900 char *cond_start = NULL;
6901 char *cond_end = NULL;
6902 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6903 tok++;
6904
6905 end_tok = tok;
6906
6907 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6908 end_tok++;
6909
6910 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6911
6912 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6913 {
6914 struct expression *expr;
6915
6916 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6917 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6918 xfree (expr);
6919 cond_end = tok;
6920 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6921 cond_end - cond_start);
6922 }
6923 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6924 {
6925 char *tmptok;
6926
6927 tok = end_tok + 1;
6928 tmptok = tok;
6929 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6930 if (tok == tmptok)
6931 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6932 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6933 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6934 }
6935 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6936 {
6937 char *tmptok;
6938
6939 tok = end_tok + 1;
6940 tmptok = tok;
6941 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6942 if (tok == tmptok)
6943 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6944 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6945 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6946 }
6947 else
6948 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6949 }
6950}
6951
6952/* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
6953 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
6954 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
6955 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6956 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
6957 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
6958 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
6959 was created; false otherwise. */
6960
6961int
6962create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6963 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6964 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6965 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6966 int ignore_count,
6967 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6968 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6969 int from_tty,
6970 int enabled)
6971{
6972 struct gdb_exception e;
6973 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6974 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6975 char *copy_arg;
6976 char *err_msg;
6977 char *addr_start = arg;
6978 char **addr_string;
6979 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6980 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6981 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6982 int i;
6983 int pending = 0;
6984 int not_found = 0;
6985 enum bptype type_wanted;
6986 int task = 0;
6987
6988 sals.sals = NULL;
6989 sals.nelts = 0;
6990 addr_string = NULL;
6991
6992 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6993 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6994 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6995 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6996
6997 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6998 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6999
7000 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
7001 switch (e.reason)
7002 {
7003 case RETURN_QUIT:
7004 throw_exception (e);
7005 case RETURN_ERROR:
7006 switch (e.error)
7007 {
7008 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7009
7010 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7011 error. */
7012
7013 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7014 throw_exception (e);
7015
7016 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7017
7018 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7019 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7020 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7021 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
7022 return 0;
7023
7024 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7025 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7026 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7027 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7028 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7029 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7030 sals.nelts = 1;
7031 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7032 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7033 pending = 1;
7034 break;
7035 default:
7036 throw_exception (e);
7037 }
7038 default:
7039 if (!sals.nelts)
7040 return 0;
7041 }
7042
7043 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7044 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7045
7046 if (!pending)
7047 {
7048 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7049 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7050
7051 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7052 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7053 }
7054
7055 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7056 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7057 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7058 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7059 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7060
7061 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7062 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7063 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7064 {
7065 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7066 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7067 }
7068
7069 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7070 are ok for the target. */
7071 if (!pending)
7072 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
7073
7074 type_wanted = (traceflag
7075 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
7076 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
7077
7078 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7079 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7080 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7081
7082 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7083 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7084 breakpoint. */
7085 if (!pending)
7086 {
7087 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7088 {
7089 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7090 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7091 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7092 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7093 cond_string = NULL;
7094 thread = -1;
7095 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7096 &thread, &task);
7097 if (cond_string)
7098 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7099 }
7100 else
7101 {
7102 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7103 if (cond_string)
7104 {
7105 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7106 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7107 }
7108 }
7109 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7110 type_wanted, tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7111 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7112 enabled);
7113 }
7114 else
7115 {
7116 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
7117 struct breakpoint *b;
7118
7119 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7120
7121 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7122 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7123 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7124 b->thread = -1;
7125 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7126 b->cond_string = NULL;
7127 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7128 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7129 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7130 b->ops = ops;
7131 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7132 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7133
7134 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7135 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7136 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7137 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7138
7139 mention (b);
7140 }
7141
7142 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7143 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7144 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7145 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7146 breakpoint. */
7147 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7148 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7149 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7150
7151 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7152 update_global_location_list (1);
7153
7154 return 1;
7155}
7156
7157/* Set a breakpoint.
7158 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7159 condition, and thread.
7160 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7161 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7162 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7163
7164static void
7165break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7166{
7167 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
7168 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7169
7170 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
7171 arg,
7172 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7173 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
7174 0 /* Ignore count */,
7175 pending_break_support,
7176 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7177 from_tty,
7178 1 /* enabled */);
7179}
7180
7181
7182
7183/* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
7184 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
7185 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
7186 not modified.
7187
7188 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
7189
7190static void
7191skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7192{
7193 struct symbol *sym;
7194 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
7195 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7196
7197 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7198
7199 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
7200 if (sym != NULL)
7201 {
7202 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
7203 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
7204 {
7205 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
7206 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
7207 *sal = start_sal;
7208 }
7209 }
7210
7211 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7212}
7213
7214/* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7215
7216void
7217resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7218{
7219 CORE_ADDR pc;
7220
7221 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7222 {
7223 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7224 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7225 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7226 sal->pc = pc;
7227
7228 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7229 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7230 if (sal->explicit_line)
7231 {
7232 /* Preserve the original line number. */
7233 int saved_line = sal->line;
7234 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7235 sal->line = saved_line;
7236 }
7237 }
7238
7239 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7240 {
7241 struct blockvector *bv;
7242 struct block *b;
7243 struct symbol *sym;
7244
7245 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7246 if (bv != NULL)
7247 {
7248 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7249 if (sym != NULL)
7250 {
7251 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7252 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7253 }
7254 else
7255 {
7256 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7257 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7258 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7259 source). */
7260
7261 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7262 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7263
7264 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7265
7266 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7267 if (msym)
7268 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7269
7270 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7271 }
7272 }
7273 }
7274}
7275
7276void
7277break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7278{
7279 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7280}
7281
7282void
7283tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7284{
7285 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7286}
7287
7288static void
7289hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7290{
7291 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7292}
7293
7294static void
7295thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7296{
7297 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7298}
7299
7300static void
7301stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7302{
7303 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7304Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7305 stop at <line>\n"));
7306}
7307
7308static void
7309stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7310{
7311 int badInput = 0;
7312
7313 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7314 badInput = 1;
7315 else if (*arg != '*')
7316 {
7317 char *argptr = arg;
7318 int hasColon = 0;
7319
7320 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7321 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7322 function/method name */
7323 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7324 {
7325 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7326 argptr++;
7327 }
7328
7329 if (hasColon)
7330 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7331 else
7332 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7333 }
7334
7335 if (badInput)
7336 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7337 else
7338 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7339}
7340
7341static void
7342stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7343{
7344 int badInput = 0;
7345
7346 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7347 badInput = 1;
7348 else
7349 {
7350 char *argptr = arg;
7351 int hasColon = 0;
7352
7353 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7354 it is probably a line number. */
7355 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7356 {
7357 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7358 argptr++;
7359 }
7360
7361 if (hasColon)
7362 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7363 else
7364 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7365 }
7366
7367 if (badInput)
7368 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7369 else
7370 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7371}
7372
7373/* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7374 hw_read: watch read,
7375 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7376static void
7377watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7378{
7379 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7380 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7381 struct expression *exp;
7382 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
7383 struct value *val, *mark;
7384 struct frame_info *frame;
7385 char *exp_start = NULL;
7386 char *exp_end = NULL;
7387 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7388 int toklen;
7389 char *cond_start = NULL;
7390 char *cond_end = NULL;
7391 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7392 enum bptype bp_type;
7393 int mem_cnt = 0;
7394 int thread = -1;
7395
7396 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7397 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7398 {
7399 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7400
7401 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7402 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7403
7404 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7405 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7406 be the thread identifier. */
7407 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7408 tok--;
7409 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7410 tok--;
7411
7412 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7413 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7414
7415 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7416 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7417 reach a "thread" token. */
7418 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7419 tok--;
7420
7421 end_tok = tok;
7422
7423 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7424 tok--;
7425
7426 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7427 calculate the length of the token. */
7428 tok++;
7429 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7430
7431 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7432 {
7433 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7434 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7435 only in a specific thread. */
7436 char *endp;
7437
7438 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7439 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7440
7441 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7442 thread ID. */
7443 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7444 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7445
7446 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7447 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7448 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7449
7450 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7451 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7452 evaluate_expression() function. */
7453 *tok = '\0';
7454 }
7455 }
7456
7457 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7458 innermost_block = NULL;
7459 exp_start = arg;
7460 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7461 exp_end = arg;
7462 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7463 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7464 prettier. */
7465 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7466 --exp_end;
7467
7468 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7469 mark = value_mark ();
7470 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7471 if (val != NULL)
7472 release_value (val);
7473
7474 tok = arg;
7475 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7476 tok++;
7477 end_tok = tok;
7478
7479 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7480 end_tok++;
7481
7482 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7483 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7484 {
7485 struct expression *cond;
7486
7487 innermost_block = NULL;
7488 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7489 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7490
7491 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
7492 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
7493 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7494
7495 xfree (cond);
7496 cond_end = tok;
7497 }
7498 if (*tok)
7499 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7500
7501 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7502 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7503 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7504 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7505 else
7506 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7507
7508 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7509 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7510 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7511 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7512 {
7513 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7514 target_resources_ok =
7515 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7516 other_type_used);
7517 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7518 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7519
7520 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7521 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7522 }
7523
7524 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7525 watchpoint could not be set. */
7526 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7527 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7528
7529 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7530
7531 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7532 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7533 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7534 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7535 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
7536 {
7537 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7538 {
7539 scope_breakpoint
7540 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7541 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7542 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7543
7544 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7545
7546 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7547 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7548
7549 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7550 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7551
7552 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7553 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7554 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7555 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7556 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7557 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7558 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7559 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7560 scope_breakpoint->type);
7561 }
7562 }
7563
7564 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7565 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7566 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7567 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7568 b->thread = thread;
7569 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7570 b->exp = exp;
7571 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7572 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
7573 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7574 b->val = val;
7575 b->val_valid = 1;
7576 if (cond_start)
7577 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7578 else
7579 b->cond_string = 0;
7580
7581 if (frame)
7582 {
7583 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7584 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7585 }
7586 else
7587 {
7588 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7589 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7590 }
7591
7592 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7593 {
7594 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7595 need to act on them together. */
7596 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7597 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7598 }
7599
7600 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7601
7602 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7603 that should be inserted. */
7604 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7605
7606 mention (b);
7607 update_global_location_list (1);
7608}
7609
7610/* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7611 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7612 in hardware return zero. */
7613
7614static int
7615can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7616{
7617 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7618 struct value *head = v;
7619
7620 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7621 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7622 return 0;
7623
7624 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7625 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7626 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7627 hardware watchpoint.
7628
7629 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7630 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7631 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7632 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7633 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7634 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7635 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7636 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7637 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7638
7639 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7640 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7641 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7642 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7643 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7644 {
7645 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7646 {
7647 if (value_lazy (v))
7648 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7649 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7650 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7651 ;
7652 else
7653 {
7654 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7655 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7656 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7657
7658 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7659 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7660 middle of some value chain. */
7661 if (v == head
7662 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7663 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7664 {
7665 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7666 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7667
7668 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7669 return 0;
7670 else
7671 found_memory_cnt++;
7672 }
7673 }
7674 }
7675 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7676 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7677 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7678 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7679 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7680 }
7681
7682 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7683 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7684 return found_memory_cnt;
7685}
7686
7687void
7688watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7689{
7690 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7691}
7692
7693static void
7694watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7695{
7696 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7697}
7698
7699void
7700rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7701{
7702 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7703}
7704
7705static void
7706rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7707{
7708 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7709}
7710
7711void
7712awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7713{
7714 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7715}
7716
7717static void
7718awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7719{
7720 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7721}
7722\f
7723
7724/* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7725 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7726
7727struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7728{
7729 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7730 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7731};
7732
7733/* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7734 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7735 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7736 command. */
7737static void
7738until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7739{
7740 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7741
7742 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7743 if (a->breakpoint2)
7744 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7745}
7746
7747void
7748until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7749{
7750 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7751 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7752 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7753 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7754 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7755 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7756
7757 clear_proceed_status ();
7758
7759 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7760 this function */
7761
7762 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7763 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7764 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7765 else
7766 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7767 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7768
7769 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7770 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7771
7772 sal = sals.sals[0];
7773 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7774
7775 if (*arg)
7776 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7777
7778 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7779
7780 if (anywhere)
7781 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7782 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7783 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7784 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7785 else
7786 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7787 at the very same frame. */
7788 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7789 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7790 bp_until);
7791
7792 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7793
7794 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7795 one. */
7796
7797 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7798 {
7799 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7800 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7801 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7802 sal,
7803 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7804 bp_until);
7805 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7806 }
7807
7808 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7809
7810 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7811 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7812 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7813 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7814
7815 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7816 {
7817 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7818 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7819
7820 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7821 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7822
7823 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7824 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7825 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7826 xfree);
7827 }
7828 else
7829 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7830}
7831
7832static void
7833ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7834{
7835 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7836 return;
7837 while (isspace (**s))
7838 *s += 1;
7839}
7840
7841/* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7842 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7843
7844 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7845 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7846 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7847 if clause in the arg string. */
7848
7849static char *
7850ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7851{
7852 char *cond_string;
7853
7854 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7855 return NULL;
7856
7857 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7858 (*arg) += 2;
7859
7860 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7861 condition string. */
7862 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7863 cond_string = *arg;
7864
7865 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7866 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7867
7868 return cond_string;
7869}
7870
7871/* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7872 process start/exit, etc. */
7873
7874typedef enum
7875{
7876 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7877 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7878}
7879catch_fork_kind;
7880
7881static void
7882catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7883{
7884 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7885 char *cond_string = NULL;
7886 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7887 int tempflag;
7888
7889 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7890 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7891 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7892
7893 if (!arg)
7894 arg = "";
7895 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7896
7897 /* The allowed syntax is:
7898 catch [v]fork
7899 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7900
7901 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7902 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7903
7904 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7905 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7906
7907 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7908 and enable reporting of such events. */
7909 switch (fork_kind)
7910 {
7911 case catch_fork_temporary:
7912 case catch_fork_permanent:
7913 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7914 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7915 break;
7916 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7917 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7918 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7919 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7920 break;
7921 default:
7922 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7923 break;
7924 }
7925}
7926
7927static void
7928catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7929{
7930 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7931 int tempflag;
7932 char *cond_string = NULL;
7933
7934 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7935
7936 if (!arg)
7937 arg = "";
7938 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7939
7940 /* The allowed syntax is:
7941 catch exec
7942 catch exec if <cond>
7943
7944 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7945 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7946
7947 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7948 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7949
7950 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7951 and enable reporting of such events. */
7952 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7953 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7954}
7955
7956static enum print_stop_action
7957print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7958{
7959 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7960
7961 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7962
7963 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7964 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7965 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7966 b->loc->address,
7967 b->number, 1);
7968 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7969 ui_out_text (uiout,
7970 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7971 : "Catchpoint ");
7972 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7973 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7974 ui_out_text (uiout,
7975 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7976 : " (exception caught), ");
7977 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7978 {
7979 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7980 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7981 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7982 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7983 }
7984 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7985}
7986
7987static void
7988print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7989{
7990 struct value_print_options opts;
7991 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7992 if (opts.addressprint)
7993 {
7994 annotate_field (4);
7995 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7996 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7997 else
7998 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7999 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
8000 }
8001 annotate_field (5);
8002 if (b->loc)
8003 *last_loc = b->loc;
8004 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
8005 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
8006 else
8007 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
8008}
8009
8010static void
8011print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8012{
8013 int bp_temp;
8014 int bp_throw;
8015
8016 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8017 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8018 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
8019 : _("Catchpoint "));
8020 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8021 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
8022 : _(" (catch)"));
8023}
8024
8025static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
8026 NULL, /* insert */
8027 NULL, /* remove */
8028 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8029 print_exception_catchpoint,
8030 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
8031 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
8032};
8033
8034static int
8035handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8036 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
8037{
8038 char *trigger_func_name;
8039
8040 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8041 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
8042 else
8043 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
8044
8045 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8046 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
8047 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
8048 tempflag, 0, 0,
8049 0,
8050 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
8051 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
8052 1 /* enabled */);
8053
8054 return 1;
8055}
8056
8057/* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
8058
8059static void
8060catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
8061 int tempflag, int from_tty)
8062{
8063 char *cond_string = NULL;
8064 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
8065
8066 if (!arg)
8067 arg = "";
8068 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8069
8070 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8071
8072 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8073 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8074
8075 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
8076 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8077 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
8078
8079 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
8080 return;
8081
8082 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
8083}
8084
8085/* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
8086
8087static void
8088catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8089{
8090 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8091 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8092}
8093
8094/* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
8095
8096static void
8097catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8098{
8099 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8100 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8101}
8102
8103/* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
8104
8105static void
8106create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8107 struct symtab_and_line sal,
8108 char *addr_string,
8109 char *exp_string,
8110 char *cond_string,
8111 struct expression *cond,
8112 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8113 int tempflag,
8114 int from_tty)
8115{
8116 struct breakpoint *b;
8117
8118 if (from_tty)
8119 {
8120 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8121 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8122 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8123
8124 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8125 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
8126 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
8127 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
8128 used for different exception names will use the same address.
8129 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
8130 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
8131 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
8132 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
8133 enough for now, though. */
8134 }
8135
8136 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
8137 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8138
8139 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8140 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8141 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8142 b->ignore_count = 0;
8143 b->loc->cond = cond;
8144 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8145 b->language = language_ada;
8146 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8147 b->exp_string = exp_string;
8148 b->thread = -1;
8149 b->ops = ops;
8150
8151 mention (b);
8152 update_global_location_list (1);
8153}
8154
8155/* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
8156
8157static void
8158catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
8159 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8160{
8161 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8162 int tempflag;
8163 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8164 enum bptype type;
8165 char *addr_string = NULL;
8166 char *exp_string = NULL;
8167 char *cond_string = NULL;
8168 struct expression *cond = NULL;
8169 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8170
8171 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8172
8173 if (!arg)
8174 arg = "";
8175 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
8176 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
8177 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
8178 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
8179 from_tty);
8180}
8181
8182/* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
8183static void
8184clean_up_filters (void *arg)
8185{
8186 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
8187 VEC_free (int, iter);
8188}
8189
8190/* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
8191 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
8192static VEC(int) *
8193catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
8194{
8195 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
8196 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
8197
8198 while (*arg != '\0')
8199 {
8200 int i, syscall_number;
8201 char *endptr;
8202 char cur_name[128];
8203 struct syscall s;
8204
8205 /* Skip whitespace. */
8206 while (isspace (*arg))
8207 arg++;
8208
8209 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
8210 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
8211 cur_name[i] = '\0';
8212 arg += i;
8213
8214 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
8215 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
8216 if (*endptr == '\0')
8217 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
8218 else
8219 {
8220 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8221 to a number. */
8222 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8223
8224 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8225 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8226 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8227 be caught. */
8228 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8229 }
8230
8231 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8232 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8233 }
8234
8235 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8236 return result;
8237}
8238
8239/* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8240
8241static void
8242catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8243{
8244 int tempflag;
8245 VEC(int) *filter;
8246 struct syscall s;
8247 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8248
8249 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8250 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8251 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8252this architeture yet."));
8253
8254 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8255
8256 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8257
8258 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8259 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8260 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8261 for his/her architecture. */
8262 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8263
8264 /* The allowed syntax is:
8265 catch syscall
8266 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8267
8268 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8269
8270 if (arg != NULL)
8271 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8272 else
8273 filter = NULL;
8274
8275 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8276 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8277}
8278
8279/* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8280
8281static void
8282catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8283{
8284 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8285 int tempflag;
8286 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8287 char *addr_string = NULL;
8288 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8289
8290 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8291
8292 if (!arg)
8293 arg = "";
8294 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8295 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8296 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8297}
8298
8299static void
8300catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8301{
8302 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8303}
8304\f
8305
8306static void
8307tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8308{
8309 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8310}
8311
8312/* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8313
8314static void
8315clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8316{
8317 struct breakpoint *b;
8318 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8319 int ix;
8320 int default_match;
8321 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8322 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8323 int i;
8324
8325 if (arg)
8326 {
8327 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8328 default_match = 0;
8329 }
8330 else
8331 {
8332 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8333 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8334 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8335 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8336 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8337 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8338 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8339 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8340 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8341 error (_("No source file specified."));
8342
8343 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8344 sals.nelts = 1;
8345
8346 default_match = 1;
8347 }
8348
8349 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8350 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8351 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8352 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8353 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8354
8355 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8356 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8357 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8358 due to optimization, all in one block.
8359 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8360 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8361 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8362 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8363 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8364 to support that. */
8365
8366 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8367 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8368 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8369 one breakpoint. */
8370
8371 found = NULL;
8372 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8373 {
8374 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8375 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8376 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8377 or at default pc.
8378
8379 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8380
8381 0 1 pc
8382 1 1 pc _and_ line
8383 0 0 line
8384 1 0 <can't happen> */
8385
8386 sal = sals.sals[i];
8387
8388 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8389 'found'. */
8390 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8391 {
8392 int match = 0;
8393 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8394 if (b->type != bp_none
8395 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8396 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8397 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8398 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8399 {
8400 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8401 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8402 {
8403 int pc_match = sal.pc
8404 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8405 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8406 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8407 || loc->section == sal.section);
8408 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8409 && b->source_file != NULL
8410 && sal.symtab != NULL
8411 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8412 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8413 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8414 if (pc_match || line_match)
8415 {
8416 match = 1;
8417 break;
8418 }
8419 }
8420 }
8421
8422 if (match)
8423 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8424 }
8425 }
8426 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8427 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8428 {
8429 if (arg)
8430 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8431 else
8432 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8433 }
8434
8435 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8436 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8437 if (from_tty)
8438 {
8439 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8440 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8441 else
8442 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8443 }
8444 breakpoints_changed ();
8445
8446 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8447 {
8448 if (from_tty)
8449 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8450 delete_breakpoint (b);
8451 }
8452 if (from_tty)
8453 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8454}
8455\f
8456/* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8457 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8458 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8459
8460void
8461breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8462{
8463 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8464
8465 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8466 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8467 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8468 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8469 && bs->stop)
8470 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8471
8472 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8473 {
8474 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8475 delete_breakpoint (b);
8476 }
8477}
8478
8479/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8480 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8481 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8482 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8483 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8484
8485static int
8486bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8487{
8488 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8489 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8490 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8491 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8492
8493 if (a->address != b->address)
8494 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8495
8496 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8497 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8498 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8499
8500 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8501 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8502
8503 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8504 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8505 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8506
8507 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8508}
8509
8510/* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8511 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8512 the bp_location array. */
8513
8514static void
8515bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8516{
8517 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8518
8519 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8520 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8521
8522 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8523 {
8524 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8525
8526 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8527 continue;
8528
8529 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8530 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8531
8532 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8533 addr = bl->address - start;
8534 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8535 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8536
8537 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8538
8539 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8540 addr = end - bl->address;
8541 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8542 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8543 }
8544}
8545
8546/* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8547 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8548 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8549 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8550 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8551 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8552 returns true on them.
8553
8554 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8555 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8556 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8557 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8558 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8559 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8560
8561static void
8562update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8563{
8564 struct breakpoint *b;
8565 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8566 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8567
8568 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8569 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8570 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8571 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8572 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8573 once. */
8574 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8575 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8576 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8577 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8578
8579 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8580 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8581 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8582 unsigned old_location_count;
8583
8584 old_location = bp_location;
8585 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8586 bp_location = NULL;
8587 bp_location_count = 0;
8588 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8589
8590 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8591 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8592 bp_location_count++;
8593
8594 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8595 locp = bp_location;
8596 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8597 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8598 *locp++ = loc;
8599 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8600 bp_location_compare);
8601
8602 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8603
8604 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8605 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8606 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8607 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8608 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8609
8610 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8611 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8612
8613 locp = bp_location;
8614 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8615 old_locp++)
8616 {
8617 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8618 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8619
8620 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8621 have to free it. */
8622 int found_object = 0;
8623 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8624 int keep_in_target = 0;
8625 int removed = 0;
8626
8627 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8628 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8629 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8630 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8631 locp++;
8632
8633 for (loc2p = locp;
8634 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8635 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8636 loc2p++)
8637 {
8638 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8639 {
8640 found_object = 1;
8641 break;
8642 }
8643 }
8644
8645 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8646 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8647 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8648 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8649 inserted. */
8650
8651 if (old_loc->inserted)
8652 {
8653 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8654
8655 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8656 {
8657 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8658 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8659 keep_in_target = 1;
8660 }
8661 else
8662 {
8663 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8664 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8665 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8666
8667 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8668 {
8669 for (loc2p = locp;
8670 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8671 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8672 loc2p++)
8673 {
8674 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8675
8676 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8677 {
8678 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8679 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8680 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8681
8682 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
8683 access watchpoints, if the former are not
8684 supported, but the latter are. */
8685 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8686 {
8687 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
8688 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
8689 }
8690
8691 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8692 {
8693 loc2->inserted = 1;
8694 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8695 keep_in_target = 1;
8696 break;
8697 }
8698 }
8699 }
8700 }
8701 }
8702
8703 if (!keep_in_target)
8704 {
8705 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8706 {
8707 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8708 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8709 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8710 succeed next time.
8711
8712 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8713 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8714 after calling us. */
8715 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8716 old_loc->owner->number);
8717 }
8718 removed = 1;
8719 }
8720 }
8721
8722 if (!found_object)
8723 {
8724 if (removed && non_stop
8725 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8726 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8727 {
8728 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8729 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8730 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8731 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8732 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8733 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8734 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8735 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8736 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8737 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8738 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8739 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8740 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8741 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8742 SIGTRAP.
8743
8744 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8745 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8746
8747 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8748 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8749 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8750 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8751 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8752 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8753 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8754 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8755 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8756 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8757 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8758 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8759 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8760 thread_count.
8761
8762 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8763 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8764 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8765 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8766
8767 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8768 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8769 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8770 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8771 traps we can no longer explain. */
8772
8773 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8774 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8775
8776 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8777 }
8778 else
8779 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8780 }
8781 }
8782
8783 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8784 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8785 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8786 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8787 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8788 are sorted first for the same address.
8789
8790 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8791 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8792
8793 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8794 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8795 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8796 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8797 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8798 {
8799 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8800 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8801
8802 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8803 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8804 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8805 || !loc->enabled
8806 || loc->shlib_disabled
8807 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8808 || tracepoint_type (b))
8809 continue;
8810
8811 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8812 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8813 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8814 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8815 "actually inserted"));
8816
8817 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8818 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8819 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8820 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8821 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8822 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8823 else
8824 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8825
8826 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8827 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8828 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8829 {
8830 *loc_first_p = loc;
8831 loc->duplicate = 0;
8832 continue;
8833 }
8834
8835 loc->duplicate = 1;
8836
8837 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8838 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8839 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8840 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8841 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8842 }
8843
8844 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8845 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8846 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8847 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8848
8849 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8850}
8851
8852void
8853breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8854{
8855 struct bp_location *loc;
8856 int ix;
8857
8858 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8859 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8860 {
8861 free_bp_location (loc);
8862 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8863 --ix;
8864 }
8865}
8866
8867static void
8868update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8869{
8870 struct gdb_exception e;
8871 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8872 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8873}
8874
8875/* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8876static void
8877bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8878{
8879 bpstat bs;
8880 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8881 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8882 {
8883 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8884 bs->old_val = NULL;
8885 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8886 }
8887}
8888
8889/* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8890static int
8891bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8892{
8893 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8894 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8895 return 0;
8896}
8897
8898/* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8899 structures. */
8900
8901void
8902delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8903{
8904 struct breakpoint *b;
8905 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8906
8907 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8908
8909 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8910 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8911
8912 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8913 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8914 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8915 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8916 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8917
8918 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8919 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8920 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8921 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8922 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8923 return;
8924
8925 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
8926 breakpoints gets resolved. */
8927 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
8928 {
8929 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
8930 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
8931 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8932 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8933 }
8934
8935 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8936
8937 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8938 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8939
8940 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8941 if (b->next == bpt)
8942 {
8943 b->next = bpt->next;
8944 break;
8945 }
8946
8947 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8948 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8949 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
8950 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8951 xfree (bpt->exp);
8952 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8953 value_free (bpt->val);
8954 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8955 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8956 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8957
8958 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8959 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8960 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8961 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8962 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8963 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8964 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8965 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8966 with commands won't work. */
8967
8968 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8969
8970 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8971 list, update the global location list. This
8972 will remove locations that used to belong to
8973 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8974 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8975 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8976 design to have location completely self-contained,
8977 but it's not the case now. */
8978 update_global_location_list (0);
8979
8980
8981 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8982 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8983 bpt->type = bp_none;
8984
8985 xfree (bpt);
8986}
8987
8988static void
8989do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8990{
8991 delete_breakpoint (b);
8992}
8993
8994struct cleanup *
8995make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8996{
8997 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8998}
8999
9000void
9001delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9002{
9003 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9004
9005 dont_repeat ();
9006
9007 if (arg == 0)
9008 {
9009 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9010
9011 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9012 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9013 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9014 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9015 {
9016 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9017 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9018 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9019 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9020 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9021 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9022 && b->number >= 0)
9023 {
9024 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9025 break;
9026 }
9027 }
9028
9029 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9030 if (!from_tty
9031 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
9032 {
9033 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9034 {
9035 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9036 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9037 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9038 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9039 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9040 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9041 && b->number >= 0)
9042 delete_breakpoint (b);
9043 }
9044 }
9045 }
9046 else
9047 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9048}
9049
9050static int
9051all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
9052{
9053 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9054 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
9055 return 0;
9056 return 1;
9057}
9058
9059/* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
9060 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
9061 Null names are ignored. */
9062
9063static int
9064ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
9065{
9066 struct bp_location *l;
9067 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
9068 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
9069 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
9070
9071 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
9072 {
9073 const char **slot;
9074 const char *name = l->function_name;
9075
9076 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
9077 if (name == NULL)
9078 continue;
9079
9080 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
9081 INSERT);
9082 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
9083 NULL. */
9084 if (*slot != NULL)
9085 {
9086 htab_delete (htab);
9087 return 1;
9088 }
9089 *slot = name;
9090 }
9091
9092 htab_delete (htab);
9093 return 0;
9094}
9095
9096static void
9097update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
9098 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
9099{
9100 int i;
9101 char *s;
9102 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
9103
9104 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
9105 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
9106 the common case where all locations are in the same
9107 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
9108 retain the location, so that when the library
9109 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
9110 status of the individual locations. */
9111 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
9112 return;
9113
9114 b->loc = NULL;
9115
9116 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9117 {
9118 struct bp_location *new_loc =
9119 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
9120
9121 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
9122 old symtab. */
9123 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
9124 {
9125 struct gdb_exception e;
9126
9127 s = b->cond_string;
9128 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9129 {
9130 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
9131 0);
9132 }
9133 if (e.reason < 0)
9134 {
9135 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
9136 b->number, e.message);
9137 new_loc->enabled = 0;
9138 }
9139 }
9140
9141 if (b->source_file != NULL)
9142 xfree (b->source_file);
9143 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
9144 b->source_file = NULL;
9145 else
9146 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
9147
9148 if (b->line_number == 0)
9149 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
9150 }
9151
9152 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
9153 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9154 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9155
9156 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
9157 {
9158 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
9159 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
9160 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
9161 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
9162 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
9163 often enough until a better solution is found. */
9164 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
9165
9166 for (; e; e = e->next)
9167 {
9168 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
9169 {
9170 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
9171 if (have_ambiguous_names)
9172 {
9173 for (; l; l = l->next)
9174 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
9175 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
9176 {
9177 l->enabled = 0;
9178 break;
9179 }
9180 }
9181 else
9182 {
9183 for (; l; l = l->next)
9184 if (l->function_name
9185 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
9186 {
9187 l->enabled = 0;
9188 break;
9189 }
9190 }
9191 }
9192 }
9193 }
9194
9195 update_global_location_list (1);
9196}
9197
9198
9199/* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
9200 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
9201 Unused in this case. */
9202
9203static int
9204breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
9205{
9206 /* get past catch_errs */
9207 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
9208 struct value *mark;
9209 int i;
9210 int not_found = 0;
9211 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
9212 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
9213 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
9214 char *s;
9215 enum enable_state save_enable;
9216 struct gdb_exception e;
9217 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
9218
9219 switch (b->type)
9220 {
9221 case bp_none:
9222 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9223 b->number);
9224 return 0;
9225 case bp_breakpoint:
9226 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9227 case bp_tracepoint:
9228 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9229 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
9230 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9231 return 0;
9232
9233 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9234 {
9235 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9236 delete_breakpoint (b);
9237 return 0;
9238 }
9239
9240 set_language (b->language);
9241 input_radix = b->input_radix;
9242 s = b->addr_string;
9243
9244 save_current_space_and_thread ();
9245 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9246
9247 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9248 {
9249 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9250 not_found_ptr);
9251 }
9252 if (e.reason < 0)
9253 {
9254 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9255 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9256 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9257 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9258 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9259 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9260 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
9261 if (not_found
9262 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9263 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9264 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9265 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9266
9267 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9268 {
9269 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9270 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9271 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9272 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9273 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9274 which approach is better. */
9275 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9276 throw_exception (e);
9277 }
9278 }
9279
9280 if (!not_found)
9281 {
9282 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9283
9284 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9285 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9286 {
9287 char *cond_string = 0;
9288 int thread = -1;
9289 int task = 0;
9290
9291 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9292 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9293 if (cond_string)
9294 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9295 b->thread = thread;
9296 b->task = task;
9297 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9298 }
9299
9300 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9301 }
9302
9303 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9304 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9305 break;
9306
9307 case bp_watchpoint:
9308 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9309 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9310 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9311 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9312 or it can be on local variables.
9313
9314 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9315 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9316 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9317 and unloaded.
9318
9319 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9320 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9321 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9322 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9323 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9324 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9325
9326 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9327 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9328 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9329 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9330
9331 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9332 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9333
9334 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9335 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9336 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9337 break;
9338 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9339 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9340 loaded. */
9341 case bp_catchpoint:
9342 break;
9343
9344 default:
9345 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9346 /* fall through */
9347 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9348 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9349 case bp_overlay_event:
9350 case bp_longjmp_master:
9351 delete_breakpoint (b);
9352 break;
9353
9354 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9355 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9356 case bp_shlib_event:
9357
9358 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9359 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9360 case bp_thread_event:
9361
9362 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9363 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9364 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9365 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9366 case bp_until:
9367 case bp_finish:
9368 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9369 case bp_call_dummy:
9370 case bp_step_resume:
9371 case bp_longjmp:
9372 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9373 case bp_jit_event:
9374 break;
9375 }
9376
9377 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9378 return 0;
9379}
9380
9381/* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9382void
9383breakpoint_re_set (void)
9384{
9385 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9386 enum language save_language;
9387 int save_input_radix;
9388 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9389
9390 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9391 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9392 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9393
9394 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9395 {
9396 /* Format possible error msg */
9397 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9398 b->number);
9399 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9400 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9401 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9402 }
9403 set_language (save_language);
9404 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9405
9406 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9407
9408 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9409
9410 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9411 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9412 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9413 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9414 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9415}
9416\f
9417/* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9418
9419 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9420 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9421void
9422breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9423{
9424 if (b->thread != -1)
9425 {
9426 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9427 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9428
9429 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9430 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9431 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9432 as well. */
9433 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9434 }
9435}
9436
9437/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9438 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9439 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9440
9441void
9442set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9443{
9444 struct breakpoint *b;
9445
9446 if (count < 0)
9447 count = 0;
9448
9449 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9450 if (b->number == bptnum)
9451 {
9452 b->ignore_count = count;
9453 if (from_tty)
9454 {
9455 if (count == 0)
9456 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9457 bptnum);
9458 else if (count == 1)
9459 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9460 bptnum);
9461 else
9462 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9463 count, bptnum);
9464 }
9465 breakpoints_changed ();
9466 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9467 return;
9468 }
9469
9470 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9471}
9472
9473void
9474make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9475{
9476 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9477 b->silent = 1;
9478}
9479
9480/* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9481
9482static void
9483ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9484{
9485 char *p = args;
9486 int num;
9487
9488 if (p == 0)
9489 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9490
9491 num = get_number (&p);
9492 if (num == 0)
9493 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9494 if (*p == 0)
9495 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9496
9497 set_ignore_count (num,
9498 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9499 from_tty);
9500 if (from_tty)
9501 printf_filtered ("\n");
9502}
9503\f
9504/* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9505 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9506
9507static void
9508map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9509{
9510 char *p = args;
9511 char *p1;
9512 int num;
9513 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9514 int match;
9515
9516 if (p == 0)
9517 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9518
9519 while (*p)
9520 {
9521 match = 0;
9522 p1 = p;
9523
9524 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9525 if (num == 0)
9526 {
9527 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9528 }
9529 else
9530 {
9531 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9532 if (b->number == num)
9533 {
9534 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9535 match = 1;
9536 function (b);
9537 if (related_breakpoint)
9538 function (related_breakpoint);
9539 break;
9540 }
9541 if (match == 0)
9542 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9543 }
9544 p = p1;
9545 }
9546}
9547
9548static struct bp_location *
9549find_location_by_number (char *number)
9550{
9551 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9552 char *p1;
9553 int bp_num;
9554 int loc_num;
9555 struct breakpoint *b;
9556 struct bp_location *loc;
9557
9558 *dot = '\0';
9559
9560 p1 = number;
9561 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9562 if (bp_num == 0)
9563 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9564
9565 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9566 if (b->number == bp_num)
9567 {
9568 break;
9569 }
9570
9571 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9572 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9573
9574 p1 = dot+1;
9575 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9576 if (loc_num == 0)
9577 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9578
9579 --loc_num;
9580 loc = b->loc;
9581 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9582 ;
9583 if (!loc)
9584 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9585
9586 return loc;
9587}
9588
9589
9590/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9591 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9592 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9593
9594void
9595disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9596{
9597 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9598 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9599 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9600 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9601 return;
9602
9603 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9604 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9605 return;
9606
9607 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9608
9609 update_global_location_list (0);
9610
9611 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9612}
9613
9614static void
9615disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9616{
9617 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9618 if (args == 0)
9619 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9620 switch (bpt->type)
9621 {
9622 case bp_none:
9623 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9624 bpt->number);
9625 continue;
9626 case bp_breakpoint:
9627 case bp_tracepoint:
9628 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9629 case bp_catchpoint:
9630 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9631 case bp_watchpoint:
9632 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9633 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9634 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9635 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9636 default:
9637 continue;
9638 }
9639 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9640 {
9641 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9642 if (loc)
9643 loc->enabled = 0;
9644 update_global_location_list (0);
9645 }
9646 else
9647 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9648}
9649
9650static void
9651do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9652{
9653 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9654 struct value *mark;
9655
9656 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9657 {
9658 int i;
9659 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9660 target_resources_ok =
9661 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9662 i + 1, 0);
9663 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9664 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9665 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9666 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9667 }
9668
9669 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9670 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9671 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9672 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9673 {
9674 struct gdb_exception e;
9675
9676 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9677 {
9678 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9679 }
9680 if (e.reason < 0)
9681 {
9682 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9683 bpt->number);
9684 return;
9685 }
9686 }
9687
9688 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9689 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9690 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9691 update_global_location_list (1);
9692 breakpoints_changed ();
9693
9694 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9695}
9696
9697
9698void
9699enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9700{
9701 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9702}
9703
9704/* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9705 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9706 in stopping the inferior. */
9707
9708static void
9709enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9710{
9711 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9712 if (args == 0)
9713 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9714 switch (bpt->type)
9715 {
9716 case bp_none:
9717 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9718 bpt->number);
9719 continue;
9720 case bp_breakpoint:
9721 case bp_tracepoint:
9722 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9723 case bp_catchpoint:
9724 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9725 case bp_watchpoint:
9726 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9727 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9728 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9729 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9730 default:
9731 continue;
9732 }
9733 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9734 {
9735 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9736 if (loc)
9737 loc->enabled = 1;
9738 update_global_location_list (1);
9739 }
9740 else
9741 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9742}
9743
9744static void
9745enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9746{
9747 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9748}
9749
9750static void
9751enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9752{
9753 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9754}
9755
9756static void
9757enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9758{
9759 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9760}
9761
9762static void
9763enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9764{
9765 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9766}
9767\f
9768static void
9769set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9770{
9771}
9772
9773static void
9774show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9775{
9776}
9777
9778/* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9779 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9780 GDB itself. */
9781
9782static void
9783invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9784 const bfd_byte *data)
9785{
9786 struct breakpoint *bp;
9787
9788 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9789 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9790 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9791 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9792 {
9793 struct bp_location *loc;
9794
9795 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9796 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9797 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9798 && addr + len > loc->address)
9799 {
9800 value_free (bp->val);
9801 bp->val = NULL;
9802 bp->val_valid = 0;
9803 }
9804 }
9805}
9806
9807/* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9808
9809struct symtabs_and_lines
9810decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9811{
9812 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9813 if (string == 0)
9814 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9815 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9816 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9817 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9818 default_breakpoint_line,
9819 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9820 else
9821 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9822 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9823 if (*string)
9824 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9825 return sals;
9826}
9827
9828/* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9829 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9830 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9831 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9832 someday. */
9833
9834void *
9835deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9836 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9837{
9838 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9839
9840 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9841
9842 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9843 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9844
9845 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9846 {
9847 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9848 xfree (bp_tgt);
9849 return NULL;
9850 }
9851
9852 return bp_tgt;
9853}
9854
9855/* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9856
9857int
9858deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9859{
9860 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9861 int ret;
9862
9863 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9864 xfree (bp_tgt);
9865
9866 return ret;
9867}
9868
9869/* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9870
9871static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9872static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9873
9874/* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9875
9876void
9877insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9878 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9879{
9880 void **bpt_p;
9881
9882 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9883 {
9884 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9885 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9886 }
9887 else
9888 {
9889 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9890 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9891 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9892 }
9893
9894 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9895 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9896 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9897 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9898 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9899 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9900
9901 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9902 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9903 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9904 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9905}
9906
9907/* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9908
9909void
9910remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9911{
9912 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9913
9914 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9915 call. */
9916 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9917 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9918 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9919 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9920
9921 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9922 {
9923 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9924 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9925 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9926 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9927 }
9928}
9929
9930/* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9931
9932static int
9933single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9934{
9935 int i;
9936
9937 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9938 {
9939 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9940 if (bp_tgt
9941 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9942 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9943 aspace, pc))
9944 return 1;
9945 }
9946
9947 return 0;
9948}
9949
9950/* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9951 non-zero otherwise. */
9952static int
9953is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9954{
9955 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9956 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9957 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9958 return 1;
9959 else
9960 return 0;
9961}
9962
9963int
9964catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9965{
9966 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9967
9968 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9969}
9970
9971int
9972catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9973{
9974 struct breakpoint *bp;
9975
9976 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9977 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9978 {
9979 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9980 {
9981 int i, iter;
9982 for (i = 0;
9983 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9984 i++)
9985 if (syscall_number == iter)
9986 return 1;
9987 }
9988 else
9989 return 1;
9990 }
9991
9992 return 0;
9993}
9994
9995/* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9996static char **
9997catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9998 char *text, char *word)
9999{
10000 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
10001 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
10002}
10003
10004/* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
10005
10006/* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
10007static void
10008set_tracepoint_count (int num)
10009{
10010 tracepoint_count = num;
10011 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
10012}
10013
10014void
10015trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10016{
10017 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10018 arg,
10019 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10020 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
10021 1 /* traceflag */,
10022 0 /* Ignore count */,
10023 pending_break_support,
10024 NULL,
10025 from_tty,
10026 1 /* enabled */))
10027 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10028}
10029
10030void
10031ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10032{
10033 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10034 arg,
10035 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10036 0 /* tempflag */, 1 /* hardwareflag */,
10037 1 /* traceflag */,
10038 0 /* Ignore count */,
10039 pending_break_support,
10040 NULL,
10041 from_tty,
10042 1 /* enabled */))
10043 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10044}
10045
10046/* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
10047 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
10048 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
10049 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
10050 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
10051
10052struct breakpoint *
10053create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
10054{
10055 char buf[100];
10056 struct breakpoint *tp;
10057
10058 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address. */
10059 sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
10060
10061 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10062 buf,
10063 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10064 0 /* tempflag */,
10065 (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
10066 1 /* traceflag */,
10067 0 /* Ignore count */,
10068 pending_break_support,
10069 NULL,
10070 0 /* from_tty */,
10071 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
10072 return NULL;
10073
10074 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10075
10076 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
10077 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
10078
10079 if (utp->pass > 0)
10080 {
10081 sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
10082
10083 trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
10084 }
10085
10086 if (utp->cond)
10087 {
10088 printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
10089 }
10090
10091 if (utp->numactions > 0)
10092 {
10093 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10094 }
10095
10096 if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
10097 {
10098 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10099 }
10100
10101 return tp;
10102 }
10103
10104/* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
10105 omitted. */
10106
10107static void
10108tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
10109{
10110 struct breakpoint *b;
10111 int tps_to_list = 0;
10112
10113 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
10114 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
10115 {
10116 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10117 {
10118 if (b->number >= 0)
10119 {
10120 tps_to_list = 1;
10121 break;
10122 }
10123 }
10124 if (!tps_to_list)
10125 {
10126 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
10127 return;
10128 }
10129 }
10130
10131 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
10132 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
10133}
10134
10135/* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
10136 Not supported by all targets. */
10137static void
10138enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10139{
10140 enable_command (args, from_tty);
10141}
10142
10143/* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
10144 Not supported by all targets. */
10145static void
10146disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10147{
10148 disable_command (args, from_tty);
10149}
10150
10151/* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
10152static void
10153delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10154{
10155 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
10156
10157 dont_repeat ();
10158
10159 if (arg == 0)
10160 {
10161 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
10162
10163 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
10164 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
10165 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
10166 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10167 {
10168 if (b->number >= 0)
10169 {
10170 breaks_to_delete = 1;
10171 break;
10172 }
10173 }
10174
10175 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
10176 if (!from_tty
10177 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
10178 {
10179 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
10180 {
10181 if (tracepoint_type (b)
10182 && b->number >= 0)
10183 delete_breakpoint (b);
10184 }
10185 }
10186 }
10187 else
10188 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
10189}
10190
10191/* Set passcount for tracepoint.
10192
10193 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
10194 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
10195 Also accepts special argument "all". */
10196
10197static void
10198trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10199{
10200 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
10201 unsigned int count;
10202 int all = 0;
10203
10204 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10205 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
10206
10207 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
10208
10209 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
10210 args++;
10211
10212 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
10213 {
10214 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
10215 all = 1;
10216 if (*args)
10217 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10218 }
10219 else
10220 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
10221
10222 do
10223 {
10224 if (t1)
10225 {
10226 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10227 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10228 {
10229 t2->pass_count = count;
10230 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10231 if (from_tty)
10232 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10233 t2->number, count);
10234 }
10235 if (! all && *args)
10236 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10237 }
10238 }
10239 while (*args);
10240}
10241
10242struct breakpoint *
10243get_tracepoint (int num)
10244{
10245 struct breakpoint *t;
10246
10247 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10248 if (t->number == num)
10249 return t;
10250
10251 return NULL;
10252}
10253
10254/* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10255 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10256 reconnecting). */
10257
10258struct breakpoint *
10259get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10260{
10261 struct breakpoint *t;
10262
10263 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10264 if (t->number_on_target == num)
10265 return t;
10266
10267 return NULL;
10268}
10269
10270/* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10271 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10272 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10273 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
10274struct breakpoint *
10275get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10276{
10277 extern int tracepoint_count;
10278 struct breakpoint *t;
10279 int tpnum;
10280 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10281
10282 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10283 {
10284 if (optional_p)
10285 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10286 else
10287 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10288 }
10289 else
10290 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10291
10292 if (tpnum <= 0)
10293 {
10294 if (instring && *instring)
10295 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10296 instring);
10297 else
10298 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10299 return NULL;
10300 }
10301
10302 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10303 if (t->number == tpnum)
10304 {
10305 return t;
10306 }
10307
10308 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10309 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10310 allow us to discover this. */
10311 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10312 return NULL;
10313}
10314
10315/* save-tracepoints command */
10316static void
10317tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10318{
10319 struct breakpoint *tp;
10320 int any_tp = 0;
10321 struct action_line *line;
10322 FILE *fp;
10323 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
10324 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
10325 char tmp[40];
10326 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10327
10328 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10329 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10330
10331 /* See if we have anything to save. */
10332 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10333 {
10334 any_tp = 1;
10335 break;
10336 }
10337 if (!any_tp)
10338 {
10339 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10340 return;
10341 }
10342
10343 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10344 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10345 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
10346 if (!fp)
10347 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10348 args, safe_strerror (errno));
10349 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
10350
10351 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10352 {
10353 if (tp->addr_string)
10354 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10355 else
10356 {
10357 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10358 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10359 }
10360
10361 if (tp->pass_count)
10362 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10363
10364 if (tp->actions)
10365 {
10366 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10367 indent = i1;
10368 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10369 {
10370 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10371
10372 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10373 actionline = line->action;
10374 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10375 actionline++;
10376
10377 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10378 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10379 {
10380 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10381 if (cmd == 0)
10382 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10383 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10384 indent = i2;
10385 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10386 indent = i1;
10387 }
10388 }
10389 }
10390 }
10391 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10392 if (from_tty)
10393 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10394 return;
10395}
10396
10397/* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10398
10399VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10400all_tracepoints ()
10401{
10402 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10403 struct breakpoint *tp;
10404
10405 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10406 {
10407 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10408 }
10409
10410 return tp_vec;
10411}
10412
10413\f
10414/* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10415 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10416 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10417#define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10418command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10419LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10420If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10421If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10422If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10423With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10424This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10425\n\
10426THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10427CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10428\n\
10429Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10430\n\
10431Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10432
10433/* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10434static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10435
10436/* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10437static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10438
10439/* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10440 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10441static void
10442add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10443 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10444 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10445 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10446 char *text, char *word),
10447 void *user_data_catch,
10448 void *user_data_tcatch)
10449{
10450 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10451
10452 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10453 &catch_cmdlist);
10454 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10455 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10456 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10457
10458 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10459 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10460 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10461 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10462 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10463}
10464
10465static void
10466clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
10467{
10468 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10469 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10470 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10471}
10472
10473void
10474_initialize_breakpoint (void)
10475{
10476 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10477 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10478 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10479
10480 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10481 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10482 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10483
10484 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10485 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10486 before a breakpoint is set. */
10487 breakpoint_count = 0;
10488
10489 tracepoint_count = 0;
10490
10491 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10492Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10493Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10494 if (xdb_commands)
10495 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10496
10497 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10498Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10499Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10500With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10501The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10502Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10503Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10504then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10505
10506 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10507Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10508Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10509expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10510
10511 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10512Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10513Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10514so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10515by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10516\n"
10517BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10518 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10519
10520 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10521Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10522Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10523some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10524\n"
10525BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10526 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10527
10528 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10529Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10530Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10531so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10532\n"
10533BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10534 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10535
10536 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10537Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10538Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10539With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10540This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10541With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10542 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10543 if (xdb_commands)
10544 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10545Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10546Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10547With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10548This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10549With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10550
10551 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10552
10553 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10554Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10555Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10556This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10557May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10558 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10559
10560 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10561Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10562If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10563 &enablebreaklist);
10564
10565 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10566Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10567If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10568 &enablebreaklist);
10569
10570 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10571Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10572If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10573 &enablelist);
10574
10575 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10576Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10577If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10578 &enablelist);
10579
10580 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10581Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10582Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10583To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10584A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10585 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10586 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10587 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10588 if (xdb_commands)
10589 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10590Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10591Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10592To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10593A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10594
10595 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10596Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10597Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10598To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10599A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10600This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10601 &disablelist);
10602
10603 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10604Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10605Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10606To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10607\n\
10608Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10609The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10610 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10611 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10612 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10613 if (xdb_commands)
10614 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10615Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10616Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10617To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10618
10619 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10620Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10621Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10622To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10623This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10624 &deletelist);
10625
10626 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10627Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10628Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10629If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10630If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10631If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10632\n\
10633With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10634is executing in.\n\
10635\n\
10636See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10637
10638 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10639Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10640BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10641 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10642
10643 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10644 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10645 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10646 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10647
10648 if (xdb_commands)
10649 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10650
10651 if (dbx_commands)
10652 {
10653 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10654Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10655 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10656 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10657 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10658 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10659 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10660 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10661Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10662The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10663\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10664\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10665The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10666the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10667breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10668address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10669\n\
10670Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10671are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10672is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10673Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10674breakpoint set."));
10675 }
10676
10677 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10678Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10679The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10680\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10681\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10682The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10683the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10684breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10685address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10686\n\
10687Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10688are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10689is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10690Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10691breakpoint set."));
10692
10693 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10694
10695 if (xdb_commands)
10696 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10697Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10698The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10699\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10700\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10701The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10702the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10703breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10704address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10705\n\
10706Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10707are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10708is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10709Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10710breakpoint set."));
10711
10712 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10713Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10714The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10715\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10716\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10717\tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10718\tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10719\tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10720\tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10721The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10722the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10723breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10724address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10725\n\
10726Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10727are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10728is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10729Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10730breakpoint set."),
10731 &maintenanceinfolist);
10732
10733 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10734Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10735 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10736 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10737
10738 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10739Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10740 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10741 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10742
10743 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10744 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10745Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10746With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10747 catch_catch_command,
10748 NULL,
10749 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10750 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10751 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10752Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10753With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10754 catch_throw_command,
10755 NULL,
10756 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10757 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10758 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10759 catch_fork_command_1,
10760 NULL,
10761 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10762 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10763 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10764 catch_fork_command_1,
10765 NULL,
10766 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10767 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10768 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10769 catch_exec_command_1,
10770 NULL,
10771 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10772 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10773 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10774Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10775Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10776are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10777Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10778(if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10779 catch_syscall_command_1,
10780 catch_syscall_completer,
10781 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10782 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10783 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10784Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10785With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10786 catch_ada_exception_command,
10787 NULL,
10788 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10789 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10790 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10791Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10792With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10793 catch_assert_command,
10794 NULL,
10795 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10796 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10797
10798 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10799Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10800A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10801an expression changes."));
10802 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10803
10804 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10805Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10806A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10807an expression is read."));
10808 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10809
10810 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10811Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10812A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10813an expression is either read or written."));
10814 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10815
10816 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10817 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10818
10819
10820 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10821 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10822 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10823 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10824Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10825Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10826If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10827such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10828created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10829hardware.)"),
10830 NULL,
10831 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10832 &setlist, &showlist);
10833
10834 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10835
10836 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10837
10838 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10839Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10840\n"
10841BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10842Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10843 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10844
10845 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10846 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10847 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10848 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10849
10850 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10851Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10852\n"
10853BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10854Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10855 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10856
10857 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10858Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10859Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10860last tracepoint set."));
10861
10862 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10863
10864 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10865Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10866Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10867No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10868 &deletelist);
10869
10870 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10871Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10872Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10873No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10874 &disablelist);
10875 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10876
10877 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10878Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10879Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10880No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10881 &enablelist);
10882 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10883
10884 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10885Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10886The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10887Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10888if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10889
10890 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10891Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10892Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10893 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10894
10895 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10896Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10897Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10898pending breakpoint behavior"),
10899 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10900 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10901 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10902Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10903Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10904pending breakpoint behavior"),
10905 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10906 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10907
10908 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10909 &pending_break_support, _("\
10910Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10911Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10912If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10913pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10914an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10915user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10916 NULL,
10917 show_pending_break_support,
10918 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10919 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10920
10921 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10922
10923 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10924 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10925Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10926Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10927If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10928breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10929a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10930 NULL,
10931 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10932 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10933 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10934
10935 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10936 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10937Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10938Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10939When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10940resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10941breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10942deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10943the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10944In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10945behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10946inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10947 NULL,
10948 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10949 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10950 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10951
10952 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10953
10954 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10955}
This page took 0.0592 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.